Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1 | ---------------------- |
| 2 | HAProxy |
| 3 | Configuration Manual |
| 4 | ---------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | 21475e3 | 2010-05-23 08:46:08 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5 | version 1.5 |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6 | willy tarreau |
Willy Tarreau | 1621682 | 2012-09-10 09:46:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7 | 2012/09/10 |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8 | |
| 9 | |
| 10 | This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version |
| 11 | specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 12 | documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual. |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 13 | The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate |
| 14 | through the document. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 15 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 16 | Note to documentation contributors : |
Jamie Gloudon | aaa2100 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 17 | This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 18 | spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly |
| 19 | so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be |
| 20 | printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 21 | ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also |
| 22 | sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3 |
| 23 | closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between |
| 24 | inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections, |
| 25 | please update the summary below for easier searching. |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 26 | |
| 27 | |
| 28 | Summary |
| 29 | ------- |
| 30 | |
| 31 | 1. Quick reminder about HTTP |
| 32 | 1.1. The HTTP transaction model |
| 33 | 1.2. HTTP request |
| 34 | 1.2.1. The Request line |
| 35 | 1.2.2. The request headers |
| 36 | 1.3. HTTP response |
| 37 | 1.3.1. The Response line |
| 38 | 1.3.2. The response headers |
| 39 | |
| 40 | 2. Configuring HAProxy |
| 41 | 2.1. Configuration file format |
| 42 | 2.2. Time format |
Patrick Mezard | 35da19c | 2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 43 | 2.3. Examples |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 44 | |
| 45 | 3. Global parameters |
| 46 | 3.1. Process management and security |
| 47 | 3.2. Performance tuning |
| 48 | 3.3. Debugging |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 49 | 3.4. Userlists |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 50 | 3.5. Peers |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 51 | |
| 52 | 4. Proxies |
| 53 | 4.1. Proxy keywords matrix |
| 54 | 4.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference |
| 55 | |
Willy Tarreau | 086fbf5 | 2012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 56 | 5. Bind and Server options |
| 57 | 5.1. Bind options |
| 58 | 5.2. Server and default-server options |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 59 | |
| 60 | 6. HTTP header manipulation |
| 61 | |
Cyril Bonté | 7d38afb | 2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 62 | 7. Using ACLs and pattern extraction |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 63 | 7.1. Matching integers |
| 64 | 7.2. Matching strings |
| 65 | 7.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes) |
Willy Tarreau | ceb4ac9 | 2012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 66 | 7.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 67 | 7.5. Available matching criteria |
| 68 | 7.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below |
| 69 | 7.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 |
| 70 | 7.5.3. Matching at Layer 7 |
| 71 | 7.6. Pre-defined ACLs |
| 72 | 7.7. Using ACLs to form conditions |
Cyril Bonté | 7d38afb | 2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 73 | 7.8. Pattern extraction |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 74 | |
| 75 | 8. Logging |
| 76 | 8.1. Log levels |
| 77 | 8.2. Log formats |
| 78 | 8.2.1. Default log format |
| 79 | 8.2.2. TCP log format |
| 80 | 8.2.3. HTTP log format |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 81 | 8.2.4. Custom log format |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 82 | 8.3. Advanced logging options |
| 83 | 8.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests |
| 84 | 8.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate |
| 85 | 8.3.3. Raising log level upon errors |
| 86 | 8.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections |
| 87 | 8.4. Timing events |
| 88 | 8.5. Session state at disconnection |
| 89 | 8.6. Non-printable characters |
| 90 | 8.7. Capturing HTTP cookies |
| 91 | 8.8. Capturing HTTP headers |
| 92 | 8.9. Examples of logs |
| 93 | |
| 94 | 9. Statistics and monitoring |
| 95 | 9.1. CSV format |
| 96 | 9.2. Unix Socket commands |
| 97 | |
| 98 | |
| 99 | 1. Quick reminder about HTTP |
| 100 | ---------------------------- |
| 101 | |
| 102 | When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are |
| 103 | fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria |
| 104 | on almost anything found in the contents. |
| 105 | |
| 106 | However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are |
| 107 | formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write |
| 108 | correct rules and to debug existing configurations. |
| 109 | |
| 110 | |
| 111 | 1.1. The HTTP transaction model |
| 112 | ------------------------------- |
| 113 | |
| 114 | The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 115 | to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 116 | from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the |
| 117 | connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request |
| 118 | will involve a new connection : |
| 119 | |
| 120 | [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ... |
| 121 | |
| 122 | In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection |
| 123 | establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed |
| 124 | by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content |
| 125 | length. |
| 126 | |
| 127 | Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it |
| 128 | to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode |
| 129 | however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each |
| 130 | response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special |
| 131 | header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode : |
| 132 | |
| 133 | [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ... |
| 134 | |
| 135 | Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing |
| 136 | power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode, |
| 137 | but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to |
Patrick Mezard | 9ec2ec4 | 2010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 138 | a smaller value. |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 139 | |
| 140 | A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses |
| 141 | keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the |
| 142 | second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a |
| 143 | page : |
| 144 | |
| 145 | [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ... |
| 146 | |
| 147 | This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network |
| 148 | latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not |
| 149 | correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with |
| 150 | the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 151 | server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received. |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 152 | |
Patrick Mezard | 9ec2ec4 | 2010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 153 | By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent |
| 154 | connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards |
| 155 | everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once |
| 156 | established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server |
| 157 | sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections |
| 158 | while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after |
| 159 | another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both |
| 160 | sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option |
| 161 | http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close |
| 162 | mode. |
| 163 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 164 | |
| 165 | 1.2. HTTP request |
| 166 | ----------------- |
| 167 | |
| 168 | First, let's consider this HTTP request : |
| 169 | |
| 170 | Line Contents |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 171 | number |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 172 | 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1 |
| 173 | 2 Host: www.mydomain.com |
| 174 | 3 User-agent: my small browser |
| 175 | 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif |
| 176 | 5 Accept: image/png |
| 177 | |
| 178 | |
| 179 | 1.2.1. The Request line |
| 180 | ----------------------- |
| 181 | |
| 182 | Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields : |
| 183 | |
| 184 | - a METHOD : GET |
| 185 | - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 |
| 186 | - a version tag : HTTP/1.1 |
| 187 | |
| 188 | All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces), |
| 189 | which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns |
| 190 | followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and |
| 191 | is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it |
| 192 | desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to |
| 193 | the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression. |
| 194 | |
| 195 | The URI itself can have several forms : |
| 196 | |
| 197 | - A "relative URI" : |
| 198 | |
| 199 | /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 |
| 200 | |
| 201 | It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is |
| 202 | received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies. |
| 203 | |
| 204 | - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" : |
| 205 | |
| 206 | http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 |
| 207 | |
| 208 | It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host |
| 209 | name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then |
| 210 | a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part. |
| 211 | This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1 |
| 212 | must accept this form too. |
| 213 | |
| 214 | - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS |
| 215 | method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's |
| 216 | capabilities. |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 217 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 218 | - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80 |
| 219 | This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP |
| 220 | tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for |
| 221 | other protocols too. |
| 222 | |
| 223 | In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question |
| 224 | mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects |
| 225 | on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string". |
| 226 | It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very |
| 227 | specific to the language, framework or application in use. |
| 228 | |
| 229 | |
| 230 | 1.2.2. The request headers |
| 231 | -------------------------- |
| 232 | |
| 233 | The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the |
| 234 | beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally, |
| 235 | an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values. |
| 236 | Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the |
| 237 | values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly |
| 238 | encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if |
| 239 | the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5 |
| 240 | define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header. |
| 241 | |
| 242 | Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and |
| 243 | their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the |
| 244 | "Connection:" header). |
| 245 | |
| 246 | The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say |
| 247 | that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed |
| 248 | is one valid form of empty line. |
| 249 | |
| 250 | Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing |
| 251 | headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry |
| 252 | about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an |
| 253 | application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things. |
| 254 | |
| 255 | Important note: |
| 256 | As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks |
| 257 | in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This |
| 258 | is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work |
| 259 | correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs. |
| 260 | |
| 261 | |
| 262 | 1.3. HTTP response |
| 263 | ------------------ |
| 264 | |
| 265 | An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP |
| 266 | messages. Let's consider this HTTP response : |
| 267 | |
| 268 | Line Contents |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 269 | number |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 270 | 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK |
| 271 | 2 Content-length: 350 |
| 272 | 3 Content-Type: text/html |
| 273 | |
Willy Tarreau | 816b979 | 2009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 274 | As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status |
| 275 | codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the |
| 276 | response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to |
Willy Tarreau | 5843d1a | 2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 277 | continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response |
| 278 | the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message |
| 279 | following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be |
| 280 | sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled |
| 281 | (1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to |
| 282 | correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As |
| 283 | such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly |
| 284 | state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing |
| 285 | over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as |
| 286 | if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional |
| 287 | information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to. |
Willy Tarreau | 816b979 | 2009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 288 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 289 | |
| 290 | 1.3.1. The Response line |
| 291 | ------------------------ |
| 292 | |
| 293 | Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields : |
| 294 | |
| 295 | - a version tag : HTTP/1.1 |
| 296 | - a status code : 200 |
| 297 | - a reason : OK |
| 298 | |
| 299 | The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status : |
Willy Tarreau | 816b979 | 2009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 300 | - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101) |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 301 | - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206) |
| 302 | - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304) |
| 303 | - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404) |
| 304 | - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503) |
| 305 | |
| 306 | Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 307 | "reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 308 | found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established |
| 309 | messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found", |
| 310 | or "Authentication Required". |
| 311 | |
| 312 | Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself : |
| 313 | |
| 314 | Code When / reason |
| 315 | 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests |
| 316 | 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code |
| 317 | 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code |
| 318 | 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code |
| 319 | 400 for an invalid or too large request |
| 320 | 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when |
| 321 | accessing the stats page) |
| 322 | 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter |
| 323 | 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete |
| 324 | 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a |
| 325 | memory allocation failure, which should never happen |
| 326 | 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or |
| 327 | when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response. |
| 328 | 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to |
| 329 | monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition |
| 330 | 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds |
| 331 | |
| 332 | The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section |
| 333 | 4.2). |
| 334 | |
| 335 | |
| 336 | 1.3.2. The response headers |
| 337 | --------------------------- |
| 338 | |
| 339 | Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses |
| 340 | the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more |
| 341 | details. |
| 342 | |
| 343 | |
| 344 | 2. Configuring HAProxy |
| 345 | ---------------------- |
| 346 | |
| 347 | 2.1. Configuration file format |
| 348 | ------------------------------ |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 349 | |
| 350 | HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters : |
| 351 | |
| 352 | - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence |
| 353 | - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters |
| 354 | - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen", |
| 355 | "frontend" and "backend". |
| 356 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 357 | The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword |
| 358 | referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters |
| 359 | delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 360 | preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 361 | escaped by doubling them. |
| 362 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 363 | |
| 364 | 2.2. Time format |
| 365 | ---------------- |
| 366 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 367 | Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 368 | values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated |
| 369 | otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the |
| 370 | numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated |
| 371 | for every keyword. Supported units are : |
| 372 | |
| 373 | - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second |
| 374 | - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default. |
| 375 | - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms |
| 376 | - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms |
| 377 | - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms |
| 378 | - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms |
| 379 | |
| 380 | |
Patrick Mezard | 35da19c | 2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 381 | 2.3. Examples |
| 382 | ------------- |
| 383 | |
| 384 | # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all |
| 385 | # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a |
| 386 | # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000 |
| 387 | global |
| 388 | daemon |
| 389 | maxconn 256 |
| 390 | |
| 391 | defaults |
| 392 | mode http |
| 393 | timeout connect 5000ms |
| 394 | timeout client 50000ms |
| 395 | timeout server 50000ms |
| 396 | |
| 397 | frontend http-in |
| 398 | bind *:80 |
| 399 | default_backend servers |
| 400 | |
| 401 | backend servers |
| 402 | server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32 |
| 403 | |
| 404 | |
| 405 | # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but |
| 406 | # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode. |
| 407 | global |
| 408 | daemon |
| 409 | maxconn 256 |
| 410 | |
| 411 | defaults |
| 412 | mode http |
| 413 | timeout connect 5000ms |
| 414 | timeout client 50000ms |
| 415 | timeout server 50000ms |
| 416 | |
| 417 | listen http-in |
| 418 | bind *:80 |
| 419 | server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32 |
| 420 | |
| 421 | |
| 422 | Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with: |
| 423 | |
Willy Tarreau | ccb289d | 2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 424 | $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c |
Patrick Mezard | 35da19c | 2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 425 | |
| 426 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 427 | 3. Global parameters |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 428 | -------------------- |
| 429 | |
| 430 | Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They |
| 431 | are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some |
| 432 | of them have command-line equivalents. |
| 433 | |
| 434 | The following keywords are supported in the "global" section : |
| 435 | |
| 436 | * Process management and security |
Emeric Brun | c8e8d12 | 2012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 437 | - ca-base |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 438 | - chroot |
Emeric Brun | c8e8d12 | 2012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 439 | - crt-base |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 440 | - daemon |
| 441 | - gid |
| 442 | - group |
| 443 | - log |
Joe Williams | df5b38f | 2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 444 | - log-send-hostname |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 445 | - nbproc |
| 446 | - pidfile |
| 447 | - uid |
| 448 | - ulimit-n |
| 449 | - user |
Willy Tarreau | fbee713 | 2007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 450 | - stats |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 48cb2ae | 2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 451 | - node |
| 452 | - description |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 453 | - unix-bind |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 454 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 455 | * Performance tuning |
| 456 | - maxconn |
Willy Tarreau | 81c25d0 | 2011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 457 | - maxconnrate |
Willy Tarreau | ff4f82d | 2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 458 | - maxpipes |
Willy Tarreau | 403edff | 2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 459 | - maxsslconn |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 460 | - noepoll |
| 461 | - nokqueue |
| 462 | - nopoll |
| 463 | - nosepoll |
Willy Tarreau | ff4f82d | 2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 464 | - nosplice |
Willy Tarreau | fe255b7 | 2007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 465 | - spread-checks |
Willy Tarreau | 27a674e | 2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 466 | - tune.bufsize |
Willy Tarreau | 43961d5 | 2010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 467 | - tune.chksize |
Willy Tarreau | ac1932d | 2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 468 | - tune.http.maxhdr |
Willy Tarreau | a0250ba | 2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 469 | - tune.maxaccept |
| 470 | - tune.maxpollevents |
Willy Tarreau | 27a674e | 2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 471 | - tune.maxrewrite |
Willy Tarreau | bd9a0a7 | 2011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 472 | - tune.pipesize |
Willy Tarreau | e803de2 | 2010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 473 | - tune.rcvbuf.client |
| 474 | - tune.rcvbuf.server |
| 475 | - tune.sndbuf.client |
| 476 | - tune.sndbuf.server |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 477 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 478 | * Debugging |
| 479 | - debug |
| 480 | - quiet |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 481 | |
| 482 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 483 | 3.1. Process management and security |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 484 | ------------------------------------ |
| 485 | |
Emeric Brun | c8e8d12 | 2012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 486 | ca-base <dir> |
| 487 | Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a |
| 488 | relative path is used with "cafile" or "crlfile" directives. Absolute |
| 489 | locations specified in "cafile" and "crlfile" prevail and ignore "ca-base". |
| 490 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 491 | chroot <jail dir> |
| 492 | Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before |
| 493 | dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown |
| 494 | vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the |
| 495 | attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started |
| 496 | with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both |
| 497 | empty and unwritable to anyone. |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 498 | |
Emeric Brun | c8e8d12 | 2012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 499 | crt-base <dir> |
| 500 | Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative |
| 501 | path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after |
| 502 | "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base". |
| 503 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 504 | daemon |
| 505 | Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of |
| 506 | operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be |
| 507 | disabled by the command line "-db" argument. |
| 508 | |
| 509 | gid <number> |
| 510 | Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group |
| 511 | ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must |
| 512 | be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges. |
| 513 | See also "group" and "uid". |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 514 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 515 | group <group name> |
| 516 | Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group. |
| 517 | See also "gid" and "user". |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 518 | |
Willy Tarreau | f7edefa | 2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 519 | log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]] |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 520 | Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They |
| 521 | will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies |
Robert Tsai | 81ae195 | 2007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 522 | configured with "log global". |
| 523 | |
| 524 | <address> can be one of: |
| 525 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 526 | - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If |
Robert Tsai | 81ae195 | 2007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 527 | no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog |
| 528 | port). |
| 529 | |
David du Colombier | 24bb5f5 | 2011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 530 | - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If |
| 531 | no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog |
| 532 | port). |
| 533 | |
Robert Tsai | 81ae195 | 2007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 534 | - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind |
| 535 | considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside |
| 536 | the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately |
| 537 | writeable). |
| 538 | |
| 539 | <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities : |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 540 | |
| 541 | kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news |
| 542 | uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2 |
| 543 | local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7 |
| 544 | |
| 545 | An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default, |
Willy Tarreau | f7edefa | 2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 546 | all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a |
| 547 | severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum |
| 548 | level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level |
| 549 | than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending |
| 550 | "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations. |
| 551 | Eight levels are known : |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 552 | |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 553 | emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 554 | |
Joe Williams | df5b38f | 2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 555 | log-send-hostname [<string>] |
| 556 | Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter |
| 557 | is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname |
| 558 | of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an |
| 559 | intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in |
| 560 | the logs. |
| 561 | |
Kevinm | 48936af | 2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000 | [diff] [blame] | 562 | log-tag <string> |
| 563 | Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the |
| 564 | program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". |
| 565 | Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes |
| 566 | running on the same host. |
| 567 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 568 | nbproc <number> |
| 569 | Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon" |
| 570 | mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode |
| 571 | of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per |
| 572 | process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES |
| 573 | IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon". |
| 574 | |
| 575 | pidfile <pidfile> |
| 576 | Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to |
| 577 | the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user |
| 578 | starting the process. See also "daemon". |
| 579 | |
Willy Tarreau | abb175f | 2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 580 | stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*] |
| 581 | Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>. |
| 582 | Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even |
| 583 | allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please |
| 584 | consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details. |
Willy Tarreau | 6162db2 | 2009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 585 | |
Willy Tarreau | abb175f | 2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 586 | All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to |
| 587 | restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult |
| 588 | section 5.1 for more information. |
Willy Tarreau | fbee713 | 2007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 589 | |
| 590 | stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds> |
| 591 | The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible |
| 592 | to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in |
Willy Tarreau | befdff1 | 2007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 593 | milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. |
Willy Tarreau | fbee713 | 2007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 594 | |
| 595 | stats maxconn <connections> |
| 596 | By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is |
| 597 | possible to change this value with "stats maxconn". |
| 598 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 599 | uid <number> |
| 600 | Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID |
| 601 | is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must |
| 602 | be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another |
| 603 | one. See also "gid" and "user". |
| 604 | |
| 605 | ulimit-n <number> |
| 606 | Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By |
| 607 | default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this |
| 608 | option. |
| 609 | |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 610 | unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ] |
| 611 | [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ] |
| 612 | |
| 613 | Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements. |
| 614 | This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce |
| 615 | the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are |
| 616 | also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket |
| 617 | path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another |
| 618 | component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots |
| 619 | itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid> |
| 620 | all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If |
| 621 | both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the |
| 622 | "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings. |
| 623 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 624 | user <user name> |
| 625 | Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd. |
| 626 | See also "uid" and "group". |
| 627 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 48cb2ae | 2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 628 | node <name> |
| 629 | Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names. |
| 630 | |
| 631 | This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or |
| 632 | servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all |
| 633 | nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the |
| 634 | traffic. |
| 635 | |
| 636 | description <text> |
| 637 | Add a text that describes the instance. |
| 638 | |
| 639 | Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example) |
| 640 | and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using |
| 641 | "<" and ">" characters. |
| 642 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 643 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 644 | 3.2. Performance tuning |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 645 | ----------------------- |
| 646 | |
| 647 | maxconn <number> |
| 648 | Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It |
| 649 | is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting |
| 650 | connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is |
| 651 | automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". |
| 652 | |
Willy Tarreau | 81c25d0 | 2011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 653 | maxconnrate <number> |
| 654 | Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>. |
| 655 | Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be |
| 656 | used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is |
| 657 | important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure, |
| 658 | as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the |
| 659 | limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some |
| 660 | value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve |
| 661 | fairness. |
| 662 | |
Willy Tarreau | ff4f82d | 2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 663 | maxpipes <number> |
| 664 | Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes |
| 665 | are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file |
| 666 | descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default |
| 667 | value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages. |
| 668 | The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back |
| 669 | to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance. |
| 670 | |
Willy Tarreau | 403edff | 2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 671 | maxsslconn <number> |
| 672 | Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to |
| 673 | <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the |
| 674 | global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit |
| 675 | avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL |
| 676 | (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note |
| 677 | that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one |
| 678 | connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections. |
| 679 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 680 | noepoll |
| 681 | Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is |
| 682 | equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system |
| 683 | used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll". |
| 684 | |
| 685 | nokqueue |
| 686 | Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is |
| 687 | equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system |
| 688 | used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll". |
| 689 | |
| 690 | nopoll |
| 691 | Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the |
| 692 | command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select". |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 693 | It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 694 | platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and |
| 695 | "nokqueue". |
| 696 | |
| 697 | nosepoll |
| 698 | Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It |
| 699 | is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system |
| 700 | used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll". |
| 701 | |
Willy Tarreau | ff4f82d | 2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 702 | nosplice |
| 703 | Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is |
| 704 | equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied |
| 705 | using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 706 | limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between |
Willy Tarreau | ff4f82d | 2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 707 | 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not |
| 708 | be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in |
| 709 | case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and |
| 710 | "option splice-response". |
| 711 | |
Willy Tarreau | fe255b7 | 2007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 712 | spread-checks <0..50, in percent> |
| 713 | Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact |
| 714 | intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same |
| 715 | physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add |
| 716 | some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between |
| 717 | 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0. |
| 718 | |
Willy Tarreau | 27a674e | 2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 719 | tune.bufsize <number> |
| 720 | Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more |
| 721 | sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some |
| 722 | applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and |
| 723 | can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this |
| 724 | from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as |
| 725 | statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage, |
| 726 | possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn |
| 727 | parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. |
| 728 | |
Willy Tarreau | 43961d5 | 2010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 729 | tune.chksize <number> |
| 730 | Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help |
| 731 | find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply |
| 732 | more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at |
| 733 | build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better |
| 734 | checks whenever possible. |
| 735 | |
Willy Tarreau | ac1932d | 2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 736 | tune.http.maxhdr <number> |
| 737 | Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a |
| 738 | number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is |
| 739 | rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses |
| 740 | are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough |
| 741 | for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the |
| 742 | same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow |
| 743 | a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each |
| 744 | new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this |
| 745 | limit too high. |
| 746 | |
Willy Tarreau | a0250ba | 2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 747 | tune.maxaccept <number> |
| 748 | Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on |
| 749 | a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates, |
| 750 | while lower values give higher priority to already established connections. |
Willy Tarreau | f49d1df | 2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 751 | This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in |
Willy Tarreau | a0250ba | 2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 752 | multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process |
| 753 | wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a |
Willy Tarreau | f49d1df | 2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 754 | part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables |
Willy Tarreau | a0250ba | 2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 755 | the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value. |
| 756 | |
| 757 | tune.maxpollevents <number> |
| 758 | Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to |
| 759 | the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It |
| 760 | has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease |
| 761 | latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200 |
| 762 | tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth. |
| 763 | |
Willy Tarreau | 27a674e | 2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 764 | tune.maxrewrite <number> |
| 765 | Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is |
| 766 | used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never |
| 767 | fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of |
| 768 | bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large |
| 769 | numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large |
| 770 | requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers |
| 771 | to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it |
| 772 | to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is |
| 773 | larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing |
| 774 | bufsize. |
| 775 | |
Willy Tarreau | bd9a0a7 | 2011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 776 | tune.pipesize <number> |
| 777 | Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes |
| 778 | are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing, |
| 779 | it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is |
| 780 | suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are |
| 781 | performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must |
| 782 | not be changed if impacts are not understood. |
| 783 | |
Willy Tarreau | e803de2 | 2010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 784 | tune.rcvbuf.client <number> |
| 785 | tune.rcvbuf.server <number> |
| 786 | Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side |
| 787 | to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends |
| 788 | and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets |
| 789 | the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory. |
| 790 | However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in |
| 791 | order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts |
| 792 | of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though. |
| 793 | |
| 794 | tune.sndbuf.client <number> |
| 795 | tune.sndbuf.server <number> |
| 796 | Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to |
| 797 | the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends |
| 798 | and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets |
| 799 | the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory. |
| 800 | However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in |
| 801 | order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts |
| 802 | of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though. |
| 803 | Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due |
| 804 | to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before |
| 805 | notifying haproxy again. |
| 806 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 807 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 808 | 3.3. Debugging |
| 809 | -------------- |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 810 | |
| 811 | debug |
| 812 | Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking |
| 813 | into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It |
| 814 | should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full |
| 815 | system startup. |
| 816 | |
| 817 | quiet |
| 818 | Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command- |
| 819 | line argument "-q". |
| 820 | |
Emeric Brun | f099e79 | 2010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 821 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 822 | 3.4. Userlists |
| 823 | -------------- |
| 824 | It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to |
| 825 | http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this, |
| 826 | it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users. |
| 827 | |
| 828 | userlist <listname> |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 829 | Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 830 | used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers. |
| 831 | |
| 832 | group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)] |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 833 | Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 834 | attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names |
| 835 | proceeded by "users" keyword. |
| 836 | |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 837 | user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>] |
| 838 | [groups <group>,<group>,(...)] |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 839 | Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and |
| 840 | insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 841 | evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's |
| 842 | capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 843 | based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic, |
| 844 | DES-based method of crypting passwords. |
| 845 | |
| 846 | |
| 847 | Example: |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 848 | userlist L1 |
| 849 | group G1 users tiger,scott |
| 850 | group G2 users xdb,scott |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 851 | |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 852 | user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 |
| 853 | user scott insecure-password elgato |
| 854 | user xdb insecure-password hello |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 855 | |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 856 | userlist L2 |
| 857 | group G1 |
| 858 | group G2 |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 859 | |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 860 | user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1 |
| 861 | user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2 |
| 862 | user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2 |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 863 | |
| 864 | Please note that both lists are functionally identical. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 865 | |
Emeric Brun | f099e79 | 2010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 866 | |
| 867 | 3.5. Peers |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 868 | ---------- |
Emeric Brun | f099e79 | 2010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 869 | It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several |
| 870 | haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance |
| 871 | pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to |
| 872 | identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar |
| 873 | or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants. |
| 874 | Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last |
| 875 | known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to |
| 876 | the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new |
| 877 | process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication |
| 878 | during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large |
| 879 | tables. |
| 880 | |
| 881 | peers <peersect> |
Jamie Gloudon | 801a0a3 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 882 | Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section, |
Emeric Brun | f099e79 | 2010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 883 | which is referenced by one or more stick-tables. |
| 884 | |
| 885 | peer <peername> <ip>:<port> |
| 886 | Defines a peer inside a peers section. |
| 887 | If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced |
| 888 | using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer |
| 889 | connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to |
| 890 | to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to |
| 891 | identify and validate the remote peer on the server side. |
| 892 | |
| 893 | During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to |
| 894 | connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process). |
| 895 | |
| 896 | It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all |
| 897 | peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local |
| 898 | peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files |
| 899 | across all peers. |
| 900 | |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 901 | Example: |
Emeric Brun | f099e79 | 2010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 902 | peers mypeers |
Willy Tarreau | f7b30a9 | 2010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 903 | peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024 |
| 904 | peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024 |
| 905 | peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024 |
Emeric Brun | f099e79 | 2010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 906 | |
| 907 | backend mybackend |
| 908 | mode tcp |
| 909 | balance roundrobin |
| 910 | stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers |
| 911 | stick on src |
| 912 | |
Willy Tarreau | f7b30a9 | 2010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 913 | server srv1 192.168.0.30:80 |
| 914 | server srv2 192.168.0.31:80 |
Emeric Brun | f099e79 | 2010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 915 | |
| 916 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 917 | 4. Proxies |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 918 | ---------- |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 919 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 920 | Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections : |
| 921 | - defaults <name> |
| 922 | - frontend <name> |
| 923 | - backend <name> |
| 924 | - listen <name> |
| 925 | |
| 926 | A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following |
| 927 | its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults" |
| 928 | section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults" |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 929 | section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 930 | |
| 931 | A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client |
| 932 | connections. |
| 933 | |
| 934 | A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect |
| 935 | to forward incoming connections. |
| 936 | |
| 937 | A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend |
| 938 | parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic. |
| 939 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 940 | All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, |
| 941 | '-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are |
| 942 | case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies. |
| 943 | |
| 944 | Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the |
| 945 | logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two |
| 946 | proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names. |
| 947 | However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same |
| 948 | name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered. |
| 949 | |
| 950 | Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4, |
| 951 | and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 952 | bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 953 | protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding, |
| 954 | modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on |
| 955 | arbitrary criteria. |
| 956 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 957 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 958 | 4.1. Proxy keywords matrix |
| 959 | -------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 960 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 961 | The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a |
| 962 | limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because |
| 963 | they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally |
| 964 | limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 965 | marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 966 | option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default |
Willy Tarreau | 3842f00 | 2009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 967 | and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed |
| 968 | with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been |
| 969 | specified in a previous "defaults" section. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 970 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 971 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 972 | keyword defaults frontend listen backend |
| 973 | ------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+--------- |
| 974 | acl - X X X |
| 975 | appsession - - X X |
| 976 | backlog X X X - |
| 977 | balance X - X X |
| 978 | bind - X X - |
| 979 | bind-process X X X X |
| 980 | block - X X X |
| 981 | capture cookie - X X - |
| 982 | capture request header - X X - |
| 983 | capture response header - X X - |
| 984 | clitimeout (deprecated) X X X - |
| 985 | contimeout (deprecated) X - X X |
| 986 | cookie X - X X |
| 987 | default-server X - X X |
| 988 | default_backend X X X - |
| 989 | description - X X X |
| 990 | disabled X X X X |
| 991 | dispatch - - X X |
| 992 | enabled X X X X |
| 993 | errorfile X X X X |
| 994 | errorloc X X X X |
| 995 | errorloc302 X X X X |
| 996 | -- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend - |
| 997 | errorloc303 X X X X |
Cyril Bonté | 0d4bf01 | 2010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 998 | force-persist - X X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 999 | fullconn X - X X |
| 1000 | grace X X X X |
| 1001 | hash-type X - X X |
| 1002 | http-check disable-on-404 X - X X |
Willy Tarreau | bd74154 | 2010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1003 | http-check expect - - X X |
Willy Tarreau | 7ab6aff | 2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1004 | http-check send-state X - X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1005 | http-request - X X X |
| 1006 | id - X X X |
Cyril Bonté | 0d4bf01 | 2010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1007 | ignore-persist - X X X |
William Lallemand | 0f99e34 | 2011-10-12 17:50:54 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1008 | log (*) X X X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1009 | maxconn X X X - |
| 1010 | mode X X X X |
| 1011 | monitor fail - X X - |
| 1012 | monitor-net X X X - |
| 1013 | monitor-uri X X X - |
| 1014 | option abortonclose (*) X - X X |
| 1015 | option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X - |
| 1016 | option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X |
| 1017 | option allbackups (*) X - X X |
| 1018 | option checkcache (*) X - X X |
| 1019 | option clitcpka (*) X X X - |
| 1020 | option contstats (*) X X X - |
| 1021 | option dontlog-normal (*) X X X - |
| 1022 | option dontlognull (*) X X X - |
| 1023 | option forceclose (*) X X X X |
| 1024 | -- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend - |
| 1025 | option forwardfor X X X X |
Willy Tarreau | 96e3121 | 2011-05-30 18:10:30 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1026 | option http-no-delay (*) X X X X |
Willy Tarreau | 8a8e1d9 | 2010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1027 | option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1028 | option http-server-close (*) X X X X |
| 1029 | option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X - |
| 1030 | option httpchk X - X X |
| 1031 | option httpclose (*) X X X X |
| 1032 | option httplog X X X X |
| 1033 | option http_proxy (*) X X X X |
Jamie Gloudon | 801a0a3 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 1034 | option independent-streams (*) X X X X |
Gabor Lekeny | b4c81e4 | 2010-09-29 18:17:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1035 | option ldap-check X - X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1036 | option log-health-checks (*) X - X X |
| 1037 | option log-separate-errors (*) X X X - |
| 1038 | option logasap (*) X X X - |
| 1039 | option mysql-check X - X X |
Rauf Kuliyev | 38b4156 | 2011-01-04 15:14:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1040 | option pgsql-check X - X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1041 | option nolinger (*) X X X X |
| 1042 | option originalto X X X X |
| 1043 | option persist (*) X - X X |
| 1044 | option redispatch (*) X - X X |
Hervé COMMOWICK | ec032d6 | 2011-08-05 16:23:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1045 | option redis-check X - X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1046 | option smtpchk X - X X |
| 1047 | option socket-stats (*) X X X - |
| 1048 | option splice-auto (*) X X X X |
| 1049 | option splice-request (*) X X X X |
| 1050 | option splice-response (*) X X X X |
| 1051 | option srvtcpka (*) X - X X |
| 1052 | option ssl-hello-chk X - X X |
| 1053 | -- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend - |
| 1054 | option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X - |
| 1055 | option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X |
| 1056 | option tcpka X X X X |
| 1057 | option tcplog X X X X |
| 1058 | option transparent (*) X - X X |
| 1059 | persist rdp-cookie X - X X |
| 1060 | rate-limit sessions X X X - |
| 1061 | redirect - X X X |
| 1062 | redisp (deprecated) X - X X |
| 1063 | redispatch (deprecated) X - X X |
| 1064 | reqadd - X X X |
| 1065 | reqallow - X X X |
| 1066 | reqdel - X X X |
| 1067 | reqdeny - X X X |
| 1068 | reqiallow - X X X |
| 1069 | reqidel - X X X |
| 1070 | reqideny - X X X |
| 1071 | reqipass - X X X |
| 1072 | reqirep - X X X |
| 1073 | reqisetbe - X X X |
| 1074 | reqitarpit - X X X |
| 1075 | reqpass - X X X |
| 1076 | reqrep - X X X |
| 1077 | -- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend - |
| 1078 | reqsetbe - X X X |
| 1079 | reqtarpit - X X X |
| 1080 | retries X - X X |
| 1081 | rspadd - X X X |
| 1082 | rspdel - X X X |
| 1083 | rspdeny - X X X |
| 1084 | rspidel - X X X |
| 1085 | rspideny - X X X |
| 1086 | rspirep - X X X |
| 1087 | rsprep - X X X |
| 1088 | server - - X X |
| 1089 | source X - X X |
| 1090 | srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X |
Cyril Bonté | 66c327d | 2010-10-12 00:14:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1091 | stats admin - - X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1092 | stats auth X - X X |
| 1093 | stats enable X - X X |
| 1094 | stats hide-version X - X X |
Cyril Bonté | 2be1b3f | 2010-09-30 23:46:30 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1095 | stats http-request - - X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1096 | stats realm X - X X |
| 1097 | stats refresh X - X X |
| 1098 | stats scope X - X X |
| 1099 | stats show-desc X - X X |
| 1100 | stats show-legends X - X X |
| 1101 | stats show-node X - X X |
| 1102 | stats uri X - X X |
| 1103 | -- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend - |
| 1104 | stick match - - X X |
| 1105 | stick on - - X X |
| 1106 | stick store-request - - X X |
Willy Tarreau | d8dc99f | 2011-07-01 11:33:25 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1107 | stick store-response - - X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1108 | stick-table - - X X |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1109 | tcp-request connection - X X - |
| 1110 | tcp-request content - X X X |
Willy Tarreau | a56235c | 2010-09-14 11:31:36 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1111 | tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X |
Emeric Brun | 0a3b67f | 2010-09-24 15:34:53 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1112 | tcp-response content - - X X |
| 1113 | tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1114 | timeout check X - X X |
| 1115 | timeout client X X X - |
| 1116 | timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X - |
| 1117 | timeout connect X - X X |
| 1118 | timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X |
| 1119 | timeout http-keep-alive X X X X |
| 1120 | timeout http-request X X X X |
| 1121 | timeout queue X - X X |
| 1122 | timeout server X - X X |
| 1123 | timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X |
| 1124 | timeout tarpit X X X X |
Willy Tarreau | ce887fd | 2012-05-12 12:50:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1125 | timeout tunnel X - X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1126 | transparent (deprecated) X - X X |
William Lallemand | a73203e | 2012-03-12 12:48:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1127 | unique-id-format X X X - |
| 1128 | unique-id-header X X X - |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1129 | use_backend - X X - |
Willy Tarreau | 4a5cade | 2012-04-05 21:09:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1130 | use-server - - X X |
Willy Tarreau | 5c6f7b3 | 2010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1131 | ------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+--------- |
| 1132 | keyword defaults frontend listen backend |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1133 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1134 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1135 | 4.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference |
| 1136 | --------------------------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1137 | |
| 1138 | This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage. |
| 1139 | |
| 1140 | |
| 1141 | acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ... |
| 1142 | Declare or complete an access list. |
| 1143 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1144 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 1145 | Example: |
| 1146 | acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3 |
| 1147 | acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023 |
| 1148 | acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost |
| 1149 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1150 | See section 7 about ACL usage. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1151 | |
| 1152 | |
Cyril Bonté | b21570a | 2009-11-29 20:04:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1153 | appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime> |
| 1154 | [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>] |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1155 | Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie. |
| 1156 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1157 | no | no | yes | yes |
| 1158 | Arguments : |
| 1159 | <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which |
| 1160 | HAProxy will have to learn for each new session. |
| 1161 | |
Cyril Bonté | b21570a | 2009-11-29 20:04:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1162 | <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1163 | checked in each cookie value. |
| 1164 | |
| 1165 | <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from |
| 1166 | memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in |
| 1167 | milliseconds. |
| 1168 | |
Cyril Bonté | bf47aeb | 2009-10-15 00:15:40 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1169 | request-learn |
| 1170 | If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn |
| 1171 | the cookie found in the request in case the server does not |
| 1172 | specify any in response. This is typically what happens with |
| 1173 | PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before |
| 1174 | the application's session and the correct server is selected. |
| 1175 | It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability. |
| 1176 | |
Cyril Bonté | b21570a | 2009-11-29 20:04:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1177 | prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie |
| 1178 | prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the |
| 1179 | data following this prefix. |
| 1180 | |
| 1181 | Example : |
| 1182 | appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix |
| 1183 | |
| 1184 | This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX, |
| 1185 | the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX. |
| 1186 | |
| 1187 | mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode. |
| 1188 | 2 modes are currently supported : |
| 1189 | - path-parameters : |
| 1190 | The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters |
| 1191 | part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is |
| 1192 | convenient for JSESSIONID for example. |
| 1193 | This is the default mode if the option is not set. |
| 1194 | - query-string : |
| 1195 | In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the |
| 1196 | query string. |
| 1197 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1198 | When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when |
| 1199 | the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and |
| 1200 | associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from |
| 1201 | the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this |
Cyril Bonté | b21570a | 2009-11-29 20:04:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1202 | cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on |
| 1203 | the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the |
| 1204 | server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1205 | applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been |
| 1206 | unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>. |
| 1207 | |
| 1208 | The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend. |
| 1209 | |
Cyril Bonté | 02ff8ef | 2010-12-14 22:48:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1210 | Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1) |
| 1211 | unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the |
| 1212 | processes, which can result in random behaviours. |
| 1213 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1214 | Example : |
| 1215 | appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h |
| 1216 | |
Cyril Bonté | 02ff8ef | 2010-12-14 22:48:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1217 | See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table", |
| 1218 | "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process". |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1219 | |
| 1220 | |
Willy Tarreau | c73ce2b | 2008-01-06 10:55:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1221 | backlog <conns> |
| 1222 | Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size |
| 1223 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1224 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 1225 | Arguments : |
| 1226 | <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating |
| 1227 | system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1228 | connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both. |
Willy Tarreau | c73ce2b | 2008-01-06 10:55:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1229 | |
| 1230 | In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase |
| 1231 | the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just |
| 1232 | tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and |
| 1233 | sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of |
| 1234 | the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value |
| 1235 | to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can |
| 1236 | sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this |
| 1237 | backlog parameter. |
| 1238 | |
| 1239 | On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is |
| 1240 | used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of |
| 1241 | two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768). |
| 1242 | |
| 1243 | See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide. |
| 1244 | |
| 1245 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1246 | balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ] |
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com | 1c2ab96 | 2008-04-14 20:47:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1247 | balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]] |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1248 | Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend. |
| 1249 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1250 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 1251 | Arguments : |
| 1252 | <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load |
| 1253 | balancing. This only applies when no persistence information |
| 1254 | is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another |
| 1255 | server. <algorithm> may be one of the following : |
| 1256 | |
| 1257 | roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights. |
| 1258 | This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's |
| 1259 | processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm |
| 1260 | is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted |
Willy Tarreau | 9757a38 | 2009-10-03 12:56:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1261 | on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by |
| 1262 | design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some |
| 1263 | large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down |
| 1264 | for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds |
| 1265 | requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start |
| 1266 | receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is |
| 1267 | indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe |
| 1268 | it, so that you don't worry. |
| 1269 | |
| 1270 | static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights. |
| 1271 | This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is |
| 1272 | static, which means that changing a server's weight on the |
| 1273 | fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design |
| 1274 | limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes |
| 1275 | up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once |
| 1276 | the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to |
| 1277 | run (around -1%). |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1278 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2d2a7f8 | 2008-03-17 12:07:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1279 | leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the |
| 1280 | connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers |
| 1281 | of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use |
| 1282 | of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are |
| 1283 | expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well |
| 1284 | suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This |
| 1285 | algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be |
| 1286 | adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. |
| 1287 | |
Willy Tarreau | f09c660 | 2012-02-13 17:12:08 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1288 | first The first server with available connection slots receives the |
| 1289 | connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric |
| 1290 | identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which |
| 1291 | defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server |
Willy Tarreau | 64559c5 | 2012-04-07 09:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1292 | reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does |
Willy Tarreau | f09c660 | 2012-02-13 17:12:08 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1293 | not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn. |
| 1294 | The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest |
| 1295 | number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off |
| 1296 | during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server |
| 1297 | weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP |
Willy Tarreau | 64559c5 | 2012-04-07 09:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1298 | or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In |
| 1299 | order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended |
| 1300 | that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn |
| 1301 | them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to |
| 1302 | turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively, |
| 1303 | using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load. |
Willy Tarreau | f09c660 | 2012-02-13 17:12:08 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1304 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1305 | source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total |
| 1306 | weight of the running servers to designate which server will |
| 1307 | receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP |
| 1308 | address will always reach the same server as long as no |
| 1309 | server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the |
| 1310 | number of running servers changing, many clients will be |
| 1311 | directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally |
| 1312 | used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1313 | be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1314 | to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is |
Willy Tarreau | 6b2e11b | 2009-10-01 07:52:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1315 | static by default, which means that changing a server's |
| 1316 | weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be |
| 1317 | changed using "hash-type". |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1318 | |
Oskar Stolc | 8dc4184 | 2012-05-19 10:19:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1319 | uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before |
| 1320 | the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter |
| 1321 | is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of |
| 1322 | the running servers. The result designates which server will |
| 1323 | receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will |
| 1324 | always be directed to the same server as long as no server |
| 1325 | goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and |
| 1326 | anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate. |
| 1327 | Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend. |
| 1328 | This algorithm is static by default, which means that |
| 1329 | changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect, |
| 1330 | but this can be changed using "hash-type". |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1331 | |
Oskar Stolc | 8dc4184 | 2012-05-19 10:19:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1332 | This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and |
Marek Majkowski | 9c30fc1 | 2008-04-27 23:25:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1333 | "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These |
| 1334 | options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers |
| 1335 | based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter |
| 1336 | indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many |
| 1337 | characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash. |
| 1338 | Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most |
| 1339 | URIs start with a leading "/". |
| 1340 | |
| 1341 | The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth |
| 1342 | to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each |
| 1343 | slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the |
| 1344 | evaluation stops when either is reached. |
| 1345 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1346 | url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in |
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com | 1c2ab96 | 2008-04-14 20:47:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1347 | the query string of each HTTP GET request. |
| 1348 | |
| 1349 | If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1350 | request entity will be searched for the parameter argument, |
| 1351 | when it is not found in a query string after a question mark |
| 1352 | ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to |
| 1353 | wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the |
| 1354 | entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each |
| 1355 | request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB |
| 1356 | parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The |
| 1357 | default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the |
| 1358 | required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this |
| 1359 | is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first |
| 1360 | chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does |
| 1361 | not need to wait for more data than the client promised to |
| 1362 | send. When Content-Length is present and larger than |
| 1363 | <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is |
| 1364 | assumed that this will be enough data to search for the |
| 1365 | presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that |
| 1366 | Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is |
| 1367 | scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may |
| 1368 | be randomly balanced if at all. |
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com | 1c2ab96 | 2008-04-14 20:47:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1369 | |
| 1370 | If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and |
| 1371 | a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total |
| 1372 | weight of the running servers. The result designates which |
| 1373 | server will receive the request. |
| 1374 | |
| 1375 | This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure |
| 1376 | that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as |
| 1377 | long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if |
| 1378 | the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is |
| 1379 | applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP |
Willy Tarreau | 6b2e11b | 2009-10-01 07:52:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1380 | backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means |
| 1381 | that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no |
| 1382 | effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type". |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1383 | |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1384 | hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP |
| 1385 | request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function, |
| 1386 | the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the |
| 1387 | header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the |
| 1388 | roundrobin algorithm is applied instead. |
Benoit | affb481 | 2009-03-25 13:02:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1389 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1390 | An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for |
Benoit | affb481 | 2009-03-25 13:02:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1391 | reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some |
| 1392 | specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host |
| 1393 | value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered. |
| 1394 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6b2e11b | 2009-10-01 07:52:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1395 | This algorithm is static by default, which means that |
| 1396 | changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect, |
| 1397 | but this can be changed using "hash-type". |
| 1398 | |
Emeric Brun | 736aa23 | 2009-06-30 17:56:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1399 | rdp-cookie |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1400 | rdp-cookie(<name>) |
Emeric Brun | 736aa23 | 2009-06-30 17:56:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1401 | The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be |
| 1402 | looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as |
| 1403 | with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name |
| 1404 | is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded |
| 1405 | persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the |
| 1406 | same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1407 | cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is |
Emeric Brun | 736aa23 | 2009-06-30 17:56:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1408 | used instead. |
| 1409 | |
| 1410 | Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an |
| 1411 | RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this |
| 1412 | you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with |
| 1413 | a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL. |
| 1414 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6b2e11b | 2009-10-01 07:52:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1415 | This algorithm is static by default, which means that |
| 1416 | changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect, |
| 1417 | but this can be changed using "hash-type". |
| 1418 | |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1419 | See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function. |
Simon Horman | ab814e0 | 2011-06-24 14:50:20 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 1420 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1421 | <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some |
Marek Majkowski | 9c30fc1 | 2008-04-27 23:25:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1422 | algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an |
| 1423 | optional argument. |
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com | 1c2ab96 | 2008-04-14 20:47:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1424 | |
Marek Majkowski | 9c30fc1 | 2008-04-27 23:25:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1425 | balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>] |
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com | 1c2ab96 | 2008-04-14 20:47:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1426 | balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]] |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1427 | |
Willy Tarreau | 3cd9af2 | 2009-03-15 14:06:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1428 | The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other |
| 1429 | algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once |
| 1430 | for each backend. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1431 | |
| 1432 | Examples : |
| 1433 | balance roundrobin |
| 1434 | balance url_param userid |
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com | 1c2ab96 | 2008-04-14 20:47:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1435 | balance url_param session_id check_post 64 |
Benoit | affb481 | 2009-03-25 13:02:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1436 | balance hdr(User-Agent) |
| 1437 | balance hdr(host) |
| 1438 | balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only |
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com | 1c2ab96 | 2008-04-14 20:47:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1439 | |
| 1440 | Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post" |
| 1441 | extension with "url_param" must be considered : |
| 1442 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1443 | - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way |
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com | 1c2ab96 | 2008-04-14 20:47:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1444 | to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which |
| 1445 | may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to |
| 1446 | restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in |
| 1447 | the body. (see acl reqideny http_end) |
| 1448 | |
| 1449 | - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not |
| 1450 | make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and |
| 1451 | defaults to 16 kB. |
| 1452 | |
| 1453 | - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably |
| 1454 | fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin. |
| 1455 | |
| 1456 | - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to |
| 1457 | Round Robin. |
| 1458 | |
| 1459 | - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk. |
| 1460 | If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the |
| 1461 | selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little |
| 1462 | actually appeared in the first chunk). |
| 1463 | |
| 1464 | - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response. |
| 1465 | |
| 1466 | - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1467 | contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear |
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com | 1c2ab96 | 2008-04-14 20:47:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1468 | white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what |
| 1469 | might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML |
| 1470 | type message bodies. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1471 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6b2e11b | 2009-10-01 07:52:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1472 | See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and |
| 1473 | "http_proxy". |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1474 | |
| 1475 | |
Willy Tarreau | b6205fd | 2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1476 | bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*] |
| 1477 | bind /<path> [, ...] [param*] |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1478 | Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend. |
| 1479 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1480 | no | yes | yes | no |
| 1481 | Arguments : |
Willy Tarreau | b1e52e8 | 2008-01-13 14:49:51 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1482 | <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 |
| 1483 | address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will |
| 1484 | listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be |
| 1485 | listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's |
David du Colombier | 9c938da | 2011-03-17 10:40:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1486 | special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'. |
Willy Tarreau | b1e52e8 | 2008-01-13 14:49:51 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1487 | |
Willy Tarreau | c5011ca | 2010-03-22 11:53:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1488 | <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the |
| 1489 | proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1490 | above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in |
| 1491 | the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number |
| 1492 | after the last colon (':'). A range can either be : |
Willy Tarreau | c5011ca | 2010-03-22 11:53:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1493 | - a numerical port (ex: '80') |
| 1494 | - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower |
| 1495 | and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in |
| 1496 | the range. |
| 1497 | |
| 1498 | Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because |
| 1499 | every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file |
| 1500 | descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors |
| 1501 | with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each |
| 1502 | <address:port> couple must be used only once among all |
| 1503 | instances running on a same system. Please note that binding |
| 1504 | to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular |
Jamie Gloudon | 801a0a3 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 1505 | privileges to start the program, which are independent of |
Willy Tarreau | c5011ca | 2010-03-22 11:53:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1506 | the 'uid' parameter. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1507 | |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1508 | <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is |
| 1509 | alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then |
| 1510 | receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place. |
| 1511 | The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute. |
| 1512 | It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in |
| 1513 | the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix |
| 1514 | followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits |
| 1515 | for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters. |
| 1516 | |
Willy Tarreau | b6205fd | 2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1517 | <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the |
| 1518 | same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build |
| 1519 | options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please |
| 1520 | refer to section 5 to for more details. |
Willy Tarreau | a0ee1d0 | 2012-09-10 09:01:23 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1521 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1522 | It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by |
| 1523 | commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no |
| 1524 | fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in |
| 1525 | a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements |
| 1526 | in a frontend. |
| 1527 | |
| 1528 | Example : |
| 1529 | listen http_proxy |
| 1530 | bind :80,:443 |
| 1531 | bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443 |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1532 | bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1533 | |
Willy Tarreau | a0ee1d0 | 2012-09-10 09:01:23 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1534 | listen http_https_proxy |
| 1535 | bind :80 |
Cyril Bonté | 0d44fc6 | 2012-10-09 22:45:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1536 | bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem |
Willy Tarreau | a0ee1d0 | 2012-09-10 09:01:23 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1537 | |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1538 | See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol |
Willy Tarreau | b6205fd | 2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1539 | documentation, and section 5 about bind options. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1540 | |
| 1541 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0b9c02c | 2009-02-04 22:05:05 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1542 | bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ... |
| 1543 | Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers. |
| 1544 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1545 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 1546 | Arguments : |
| 1547 | all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It |
| 1548 | may be used to override a default value. |
| 1549 | |
| 1550 | odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This |
| 1551 | option may be combined with other numbers. |
| 1552 | |
| 1553 | even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This |
| 1554 | option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it |
| 1555 | with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be |
| 1556 | missing from all processes. |
| 1557 | |
| 1558 | number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between |
| 1559 | 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process |
| 1560 | number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise |
| 1561 | some instances might be missing from all processes. |
| 1562 | |
| 1563 | This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This |
| 1564 | is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same |
| 1565 | ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set |
| 1566 | 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd' |
| 1567 | and 'even' instances. |
| 1568 | |
| 1569 | At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using |
| 1570 | this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please |
| 1571 | note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first |
| 1572 | 32. |
| 1573 | |
| 1574 | If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the |
| 1575 | backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes. |
| 1576 | |
| 1577 | Example : |
| 1578 | listen app_ip1 |
| 1579 | bind 10.0.0.1:80 |
Willy Tarreau | bfcd311 | 2010-10-23 11:22:08 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1580 | bind-process odd |
Willy Tarreau | 0b9c02c | 2009-02-04 22:05:05 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1581 | |
| 1582 | listen app_ip2 |
| 1583 | bind 10.0.0.2:80 |
Willy Tarreau | bfcd311 | 2010-10-23 11:22:08 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1584 | bind-process even |
Willy Tarreau | 0b9c02c | 2009-02-04 22:05:05 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1585 | |
| 1586 | listen management |
| 1587 | bind 10.0.0.3:80 |
Willy Tarreau | bfcd311 | 2010-10-23 11:22:08 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1588 | bind-process 1 2 3 4 |
Willy Tarreau | 0b9c02c | 2009-02-04 22:05:05 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1589 | |
| 1590 | See also : "nbproc" in global section. |
| 1591 | |
| 1592 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1593 | block { if | unless } <condition> |
| 1594 | Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched |
| 1595 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1596 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 1597 | |
| 1598 | The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing |
| 1599 | if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1600 | is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is |
Willy Tarreau | 3c92c5f | 2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1601 | typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1602 | conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of |
| 1603 | "block" statements per instance. |
| 1604 | |
| 1605 | Example: |
| 1606 | acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3 |
| 1607 | acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023 |
| 1608 | acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost |
| 1609 | block if invalid_src || local_dst |
| 1610 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1611 | See section 7 about ACL usage. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1612 | |
| 1613 | |
| 1614 | capture cookie <name> len <length> |
| 1615 | Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response. |
| 1616 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1617 | no | yes | yes | no |
| 1618 | Arguments : |
| 1619 | <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order |
| 1620 | to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal |
| 1621 | sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is |
| 1622 | useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name |
| 1623 | and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX). |
| 1624 | |
| 1625 | <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which |
| 1626 | include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the |
| 1627 | standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the |
| 1628 | right if it exceeds <length>. |
| 1629 | |
| 1630 | Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the |
| 1631 | "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to |
| 1632 | check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between |
| 1633 | users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page. |
| 1634 | |
| 1635 | When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column |
| 1636 | will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the |
| 1637 | server, a "-" is reported in the response column. |
| 1638 | |
| 1639 | The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that |
| 1640 | the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the |
| 1641 | backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one |
| 1642 | "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1643 | configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1644 | specify a capture in a "defaults" section. |
| 1645 | |
| 1646 | Example: |
| 1647 | capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32 |
| 1648 | |
| 1649 | See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1650 | section 8 about logging. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1651 | |
| 1652 | |
| 1653 | capture request header <name> len <length> |
| 1654 | Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header. |
| 1655 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1656 | no | yes | yes | no |
| 1657 | Arguments : |
| 1658 | <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1659 | case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1660 | appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in |
| 1661 | upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the |
| 1662 | value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected. |
| 1663 | |
| 1664 | <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and |
| 1665 | report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if |
| 1666 | it exceeds <length>. |
| 1667 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1668 | Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1669 | value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers |
| 1670 | are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1671 | in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent |
| 1672 | headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request |
| 1673 | header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the |
| 1674 | "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1675 | differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1676 | environments to find where the request came from. |
| 1677 | |
| 1678 | Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be |
| 1679 | logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what |
| 1680 | you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the |
| 1681 | braces. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1682 | |
| 1683 | There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture |
| 1684 | is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a |
| 1685 | same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not |
| 1686 | possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section. |
| 1687 | |
| 1688 | Example: |
| 1689 | capture request header Host len 15 |
| 1690 | capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15 |
| 1691 | capture request header Referrer len 15 |
| 1692 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1693 | See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8 |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1694 | about logging. |
| 1695 | |
| 1696 | |
| 1697 | capture response header <name> len <length> |
| 1698 | Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header. |
| 1699 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1700 | no | yes | yes | no |
| 1701 | Arguments : |
| 1702 | <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1703 | case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1704 | appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in |
| 1705 | upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the |
| 1706 | value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected. |
| 1707 | |
| 1708 | <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and |
| 1709 | report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if |
| 1710 | it exceeds <length>. |
| 1711 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1712 | Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1713 | result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured |
| 1714 | request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by |
| 1715 | a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1716 | the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty |
| 1717 | string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length" |
| 1718 | header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the |
| 1719 | "Location" header to track redirections. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1720 | |
| 1721 | There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each |
| 1722 | capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent |
| 1723 | for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It |
| 1724 | is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section. |
| 1725 | |
| 1726 | Example: |
| 1727 | capture response header Content-length len 9 |
| 1728 | capture response header Location len 15 |
| 1729 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1730 | See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8 |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1731 | about logging. |
| 1732 | |
| 1733 | |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1734 | clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated) |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1735 | Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side. |
| 1736 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1737 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 1738 | Arguments : |
| 1739 | <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but |
| 1740 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 1741 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 1742 | |
| 1743 | The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or |
| 1744 | send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider |
| 1745 | during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the |
| 1746 | response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified |
| 1747 | in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is |
| 1748 | suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode |
| 1749 | (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the |
| 1750 | client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1751 | situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1752 | losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds |
| 1753 | (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). |
| 1754 | |
| 1755 | This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in |
| 1756 | "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to |
| 1757 | forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which |
| 1758 | is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning |
| 1759 | during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in |
| 1760 | the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either. |
| 1761 | |
| 1762 | This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated. |
| 1763 | Please use "timeout client" instead. |
| 1764 | |
Willy Tarreau | 036fae0 | 2008-01-06 13:24:40 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1765 | See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and |
| 1766 | "srvtimeout". |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1767 | |
| 1768 | |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1769 | contimeout <timeout> (deprecated) |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1770 | Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed. |
| 1771 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1772 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 1773 | Arguments : |
| 1774 | <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but |
| 1775 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 1776 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 1777 | |
| 1778 | If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1779 | immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1780 | cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1781 | slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the |
| 1782 | connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one |
| 1783 | has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the |
| 1784 | tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend. |
| 1785 | |
| 1786 | This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in |
| 1787 | "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to |
| 1788 | forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which |
| 1789 | is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning |
| 1790 | during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in |
| 1791 | the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either. |
| 1792 | |
| 1793 | This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently |
| 1794 | deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit" |
| 1795 | instead. |
| 1796 | |
| 1797 | See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit", |
| 1798 | "timeout server", "contimeout". |
| 1799 | |
| 1800 | |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1801 | cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ] |
Willy Tarreau | 4992dd2 | 2012-05-31 21:02:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1802 | [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ] |
| 1803 | [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ] |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1804 | Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend. |
| 1805 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1806 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 1807 | Arguments : |
| 1808 | <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or |
| 1809 | inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to |
| 1810 | the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is |
| 1811 | brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests. |
| 1812 | Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not |
| 1813 | conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same |
| 1814 | backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg: |
| 1815 | HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names |
| 1816 | between all backends if persistence between them is not desired. |
| 1817 | |
| 1818 | rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the |
| 1819 | server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the |
| 1820 | server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management |
| 1821 | of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control" |
| 1822 | headers is left to the application. The application can then |
| 1823 | decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence |
| 1824 | cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only |
| 1825 | works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is |
| 1826 | very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this |
| 1827 | mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with |
| 1828 | "insert" and "prefix". |
| 1829 | |
| 1830 | insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to |
Willy Tarreau | a79094d | 2010-08-31 22:54:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1831 | be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not |
Willy Tarreau | ba4c5be | 2010-10-23 12:46:42 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1832 | |
Willy Tarreau | a79094d | 2010-08-31 22:54:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1833 | already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this |
Willy Tarreau | ba4c5be | 2010-10-23 12:46:42 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1834 | server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server |
| 1835 | emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before |
| 1836 | processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade |
| 1837 | existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie |
| 1838 | will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the |
| 1839 | client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added, |
| 1840 | the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to |
| 1841 | caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or |
| 1842 | "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not |
| 1843 | compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix". |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1844 | |
| 1845 | prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated |
| 1846 | cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed. |
| 1847 | This may be needed in some specific environments where the client |
| 1848 | does not support more than one single cookie and the application |
| 1849 | already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie |
| 1850 | named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier |
| 1851 | and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client |
| 1852 | requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted. |
| 1853 | Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified, |
| 1854 | this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is |
Willy Tarreau | 37229df | 2011-10-17 12:24:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1855 | not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly |
| 1856 | recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server |
| 1857 | cookie updates would not be sent to clients. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1858 | |
Willy Tarreau | a79094d | 2010-08-31 22:54:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1859 | indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a |
| 1860 | client which already has a valid one for the server which has |
| 1861 | processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself, |
Willy Tarreau | ba4c5be | 2010-10-23 12:46:42 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1862 | it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In |
| 1863 | "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the |
| 1864 | requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence |
| 1865 | mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view. |
Willy Tarreau | 37229df | 2011-10-17 12:24:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1866 | Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with |
| 1867 | "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to |
| 1868 | clients. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1869 | |
| 1870 | nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode |
| 1871 | when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it |
| 1872 | ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if |
| 1873 | a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all |
| 1874 | persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for |
| 1875 | instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an |
| 1876 | outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie, |
| 1877 | leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others. |
| 1878 | See also the "insert" and "postonly" options. |
| 1879 | |
| 1880 | postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed |
| 1881 | on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the |
| 1882 | "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so |
| 1883 | this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached. |
| 1884 | Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the |
| 1885 | first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very |
| 1886 | efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a |
| 1887 | persistence cookie in the cache. |
| 1888 | See also the "insert" and "nocache" options. |
| 1889 | |
Willy Tarreau | ba4c5be | 2010-10-23 12:46:42 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1890 | preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It |
| 1891 | allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this |
| 1892 | case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it |
| 1893 | untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a |
| 1894 | logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to |
| 1895 | emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in |
| 1896 | the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404" |
| 1897 | check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful |
| 1898 | shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after |
| 1899 | they logout. |
| 1900 | |
Willy Tarreau | 4992dd2 | 2012-05-31 21:02:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1901 | httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute |
| 1902 | when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a |
| 1903 | user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components. |
| 1904 | Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute. |
| 1905 | |
| 1906 | secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when |
| 1907 | a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent |
| 1908 | never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means |
| 1909 | that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over |
| 1910 | SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on |
| 1911 | this attribute. |
| 1912 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | efe3b6f | 2008-05-23 23:49:32 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1913 | domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1914 | inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain |
Willy Tarreau | 68a897b | 2009-12-03 23:28:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1915 | name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to |
| 1916 | use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to |
| 1917 | specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple |
| 1918 | times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of |
| 1919 | domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending |
| 1920 | 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected. |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | efe3b6f | 2008-05-23 23:49:32 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1921 | |
Willy Tarreau | 996a92c | 2010-10-13 19:30:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1922 | maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle |
| 1923 | time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is |
| 1924 | sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too. |
| 1925 | Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older |
| 1926 | than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will |
| 1927 | be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the |
| 1928 | response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to |
| 1929 | prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for |
| 1930 | too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When |
| 1931 | this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always |
| 1932 | accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the |
| 1933 | ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a |
| 1934 | date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so |
| 1935 | lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off |
| 1936 | the site. |
| 1937 | |
| 1938 | maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life |
| 1939 | time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert |
| 1940 | mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date |
| 1941 | this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations |
| 1942 | of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by |
| 1943 | the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in |
| 1944 | the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set. |
| 1945 | Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are |
| 1946 | ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking |
| 1947 | kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is |
| 1948 | not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and |
| 1949 | maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to |
| 1950 | prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for |
| 1951 | too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This |
| 1952 | is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a |
| 1953 | redispatch after some absolute delay. |
| 1954 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1955 | There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be |
| 1956 | declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value |
| 1957 | indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie |
| 1958 | is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1959 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1960 | Examples : |
| 1961 | cookie JSESSIONID prefix |
| 1962 | cookie SRV insert indirect nocache |
| 1963 | cookie SRV insert postonly indirect |
Willy Tarreau | 996a92c | 2010-10-13 19:30:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1964 | cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1965 | |
Cyril Bonté | a8e7bbc | 2010-04-25 22:29:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1966 | See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" |
Cyril Bonté | 0d4bf01 | 2010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 1967 | and "ignore-persist". |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1968 | |
Willy Tarreau | 983e01e | 2010-01-11 18:42:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1969 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c6df066 | 2010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1970 | default-server [param*] |
| 1971 | Change default options for a server in a backend |
| 1972 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1973 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 1974 | Arguments: |
Willy Tarreau | 983e01e | 2010-01-11 18:42:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1975 | <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server" |
| 1976 | keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete |
| 1977 | section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more |
| 1978 | details. |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c6df066 | 2010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1979 | |
Willy Tarreau | 983e01e | 2010-01-11 18:42:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1980 | Example : |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c6df066 | 2010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1981 | default-server inter 1000 weight 13 |
| 1982 | |
| 1983 | See also: "server" and section 5 about server options |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1984 | |
Willy Tarreau | 983e01e | 2010-01-11 18:42:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1985 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1986 | default_backend <backend> |
| 1987 | Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched. |
| 1988 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 1989 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 1990 | Arguments : |
| 1991 | <backend> is the name of the backend to use. |
| 1992 | |
| 1993 | When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the |
| 1994 | "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be |
| 1995 | used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which |
| 1996 | will catch all undetermined requests. |
| 1997 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 1998 | Example : |
| 1999 | |
| 2000 | use_backend dynamic if url_dyn |
| 2001 | use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img |
| 2002 | default_backend dynamic |
| 2003 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2004 | See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe" |
| 2005 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2006 | |
| 2007 | disabled |
| 2008 | Disable a proxy, frontend or backend. |
| 2009 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2010 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 2011 | Arguments : none |
| 2012 | |
| 2013 | The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to |
| 2014 | liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance |
| 2015 | will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be |
| 2016 | created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It |
| 2017 | will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It |
| 2018 | is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled" |
| 2019 | keyword in a "defaults" section. |
| 2020 | |
| 2021 | See also : "enabled" |
| 2022 | |
| 2023 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5ce9457 | 2010-06-07 14:35:41 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2024 | dispatch <address>:<port> |
| 2025 | Set a default server address |
| 2026 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2027 | no | no | yes | yes |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2028 | Arguments : |
Willy Tarreau | 5ce9457 | 2010-06-07 14:35:41 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2029 | |
| 2030 | <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a |
| 2031 | resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved |
| 2032 | during start-up. |
| 2033 | |
| 2034 | <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent |
| 2035 | to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is |
| 2036 | possible with normal servers. |
| 2037 | |
Willy Tarreau | 787aed5 | 2011-04-15 06:45:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2038 | The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other |
Willy Tarreau | 5ce9457 | 2010-06-07 14:35:41 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2039 | server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non |
| 2040 | persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple |
| 2041 | syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to |
| 2042 | use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead. |
| 2043 | |
| 2044 | See also : "server" |
| 2045 | |
| 2046 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2047 | enabled |
| 2048 | Enable a proxy, frontend or backend. |
| 2049 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2050 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 2051 | Arguments : none |
| 2052 | |
| 2053 | The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the |
| 2054 | defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used. |
| 2055 | |
| 2056 | See also : "disabled" |
| 2057 | |
| 2058 | |
| 2059 | errorfile <code> <file> |
| 2060 | Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy |
| 2061 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2062 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 2063 | Arguments : |
| 2064 | <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of |
Willy Tarreau | ae94d4d | 2011-05-11 16:28:49 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2065 | generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2066 | |
| 2067 | <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2068 | recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2069 | the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML |
Willy Tarreau | 59140a2 | 2009-02-22 12:02:30 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2070 | error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read |
| 2071 | before any chroot is performed. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2072 | |
| 2073 | It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite |
| 2074 | errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy. |
| 2075 | This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set. |
| 2076 | |
Willy Tarreau | ae94d4d | 2011-05-11 16:28:49 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2077 | Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule. |
| 2078 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2079 | The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such |
| 2080 | as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies, |
| 2081 | force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error |
| 2082 | files returning the same contents as default errors. |
| 2083 | |
Willy Tarreau | 59140a2 | 2009-02-22 12:02:30 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2084 | The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which |
| 2085 | generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise |
| 2086 | not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid |
| 2087 | loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an |
| 2088 | error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is |
| 2089 | recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone. |
| 2090 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2091 | The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory. |
| 2092 | For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is |
| 2093 | chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2094 | simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2095 | 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL. |
| 2096 | |
| 2097 | See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303" |
| 2098 | |
Willy Tarreau | 59140a2 | 2009-02-22 12:02:30 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2099 | Example : |
| 2100 | errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http |
| 2101 | errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http |
| 2102 | errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http |
| 2103 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2104 | |
| 2105 | errorloc <code> <url> |
| 2106 | errorloc302 <code> <url> |
| 2107 | Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy |
| 2108 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2109 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 2110 | Arguments : |
| 2111 | <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of |
Willy Tarreau | ae94d4d | 2011-05-11 16:28:49 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2112 | generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504. |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2113 | |
| 2114 | <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain |
| 2115 | either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site, |
| 2116 | or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site. |
| 2117 | Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect |
| 2118 | loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500). |
| 2119 | |
| 2120 | It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite |
| 2121 | errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy. |
| 2122 | This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set. |
| 2123 | |
Willy Tarreau | ae94d4d | 2011-05-11 16:28:49 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2124 | Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule. |
| 2125 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2126 | Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the |
| 2127 | client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be |
| 2128 | quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL |
| 2129 | sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To |
| 2130 | workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303 |
| 2131 | status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET |
| 2132 | request. |
| 2133 | |
| 2134 | See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303" |
| 2135 | |
| 2136 | |
| 2137 | errorloc303 <code> <url> |
| 2138 | Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy |
| 2139 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2140 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 2141 | Arguments : |
| 2142 | <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of |
| 2143 | generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504. |
| 2144 | |
| 2145 | <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain |
| 2146 | either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site, |
| 2147 | or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site. |
| 2148 | Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect |
| 2149 | loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500). |
| 2150 | |
| 2151 | It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite |
| 2152 | errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy. |
| 2153 | This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set. |
| 2154 | |
Willy Tarreau | ae94d4d | 2011-05-11 16:28:49 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2155 | Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule. |
| 2156 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2157 | Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the |
| 2158 | client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This |
| 2159 | solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is |
| 2160 | possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2161 | it, but no such problem has been reported till now. |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2162 | |
| 2163 | See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" |
| 2164 | |
| 2165 | |
Willy Tarreau | 4de9149 | 2010-01-22 19:10:05 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2166 | force-persist { if | unless } <condition> |
| 2167 | Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers |
| 2168 | May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2169 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 2170 | |
| 2171 | By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to |
| 2172 | force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches |
| 2173 | to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little |
| 2174 | possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially |
| 2175 | marked down for maintenance operations. |
| 2176 | |
| 2177 | The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based |
| 2178 | conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of |
| 2179 | a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a |
| 2180 | server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially |
| 2181 | configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could |
| 2182 | use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has |
| 2183 | the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test |
| 2184 | page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service |
| 2185 | to the world by returning a valid response to health checks. |
| 2186 | |
| 2187 | The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an |
| 2188 | "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this |
| 2189 | is used. |
| 2190 | |
Cyril Bonté | 0d4bf01 | 2010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2191 | See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist", |
Cyril Bonté | a8e7bbc | 2010-04-25 22:29:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2192 | and section 7 about ACL usage. |
Willy Tarreau | 4de9149 | 2010-01-22 19:10:05 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2193 | |
| 2194 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2195 | fullconn <conns> |
| 2196 | Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn |
| 2197 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2198 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 2199 | Arguments : |
| 2200 | <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the |
| 2201 | servers use the maximal number of connections. |
| 2202 | |
Willy Tarreau | 198a744 | 2008-01-17 12:05:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2203 | When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2204 | of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a |
Willy Tarreau | 198a744 | 2008-01-17 12:05:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2205 | "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2206 | load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections, |
| 2207 | never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both |
| 2208 | values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This |
| 2209 | makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but |
| 2210 | push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2211 | exceptional loads. |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2212 | |
Willy Tarreau | fbb7842 | 2011-06-05 15:38:35 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2213 | Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to |
| 2214 | 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this |
| 2215 | backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset. |
| 2216 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2217 | Example : |
| 2218 | # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each |
| 2219 | # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000 |
| 2220 | # connections. |
| 2221 | backend dynamic |
| 2222 | fullconn 10000 |
| 2223 | server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000 |
| 2224 | server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000 |
| 2225 | |
| 2226 | See also : "maxconn", "server" |
| 2227 | |
| 2228 | |
| 2229 | grace <time> |
| 2230 | Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop |
| 2231 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
Cyril Bonté | 99ed327 | 2010-01-24 23:29:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2232 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2233 | Arguments : |
| 2234 | <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance |
| 2235 | will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening |
| 2236 | when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal. |
| 2237 | |
| 2238 | This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order. |
| 2239 | This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2240 | external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2241 | needed by the equipment to detect the failure. |
| 2242 | |
| 2243 | Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter, |
| 2244 | and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than |
| 2245 | simplify it. |
| 2246 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2247 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6b2e11b | 2009-10-01 07:52:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2248 | hash-type <method> |
| 2249 | Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers |
| 2250 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2251 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 2252 | Arguments : |
| 2253 | map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers. |
| 2254 | The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will |
| 2255 | be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be |
| 2256 | ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also, |
| 2257 | since a server is selected by its position in the array, most |
| 2258 | mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means |
| 2259 | that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added |
| 2260 | to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different |
| 2261 | servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance. |
| 2262 | |
Willy Tarreau | 798a39c | 2010-11-24 15:04:29 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2263 | avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described |
| 2264 | above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the |
| 2265 | mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most |
| 2266 | situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based |
| 2267 | hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of |
| 2268 | the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers |
| 2269 | multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to |
| 2270 | this value. |
| 2271 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6b2e11b | 2009-10-01 07:52:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2272 | consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each |
| 2273 | server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest |
| 2274 | server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing |
| 2275 | weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the |
| 2276 | slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server |
| 2277 | goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server |
| 2278 | is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are |
| 2279 | redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches. |
| 2280 | However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very |
| 2281 | smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's |
| 2282 | weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order |
| 2283 | to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is |
| 2284 | important that all servers have the same IDs. |
| 2285 | |
| 2286 | The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. |
| 2287 | |
| 2288 | See also : "balance", "server" |
| 2289 | |
| 2290 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2291 | http-check disable-on-404 |
| 2292 | Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks |
| 2293 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2294 | yes | no | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2295 | Arguments : none |
| 2296 | |
| 2297 | When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be |
| 2298 | excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent |
| 2299 | connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators |
| 2300 | to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note |
| 2301 | that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not |
| 2302 | generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it |
| 2303 | will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page |
| 2304 | reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this |
Willy Tarreau | bd74154 | 2010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2305 | option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option |
| 2306 | is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404 |
| 2307 | responses will still be considered as soft-stop. |
| 2308 | |
| 2309 | See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect" |
| 2310 | |
| 2311 | |
| 2312 | http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern> |
Jamie Gloudon | aaa2100 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 2313 | Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes |
Willy Tarreau | bd74154 | 2010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2314 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
Willy Tarreau | 1ee51a6 | 2011-08-19 20:04:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2315 | yes | no | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | bd74154 | 2010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2316 | Arguments : |
| 2317 | <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the |
| 2318 | response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", |
Jamie Gloudon | aaa2100 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 2319 | "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an |
Willy Tarreau | bd74154 | 2010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2320 | exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed |
| 2321 | between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more |
| 2322 | details on the supported keywords. |
| 2323 | |
| 2324 | <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular |
| 2325 | expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped |
| 2326 | with the usual backslash ('\'). |
| 2327 | |
| 2328 | By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx |
| 2329 | are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used, |
| 2330 | it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check" |
| 2331 | statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times |
| 2332 | out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are : |
| 2333 | |
| 2334 | status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code. |
Jamie Gloudon | aaa2100 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 2335 | A health check response will be considered valid if the |
Willy Tarreau | bd74154 | 2010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2336 | response's status code is exactly this string. If the |
| 2337 | "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response |
| 2338 | will be considered invalid if the status code matches. |
| 2339 | |
| 2340 | rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code. |
Jamie Gloudon | aaa2100 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 2341 | A health check response will be considered valid if the |
Willy Tarreau | bd74154 | 2010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2342 | response's status code matches the expression. If the |
| 2343 | "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response |
| 2344 | will be considered invalid if the status code matches. |
| 2345 | This is mostly used to check for multiple codes. |
| 2346 | |
| 2347 | string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body. |
Jamie Gloudon | aaa2100 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 2348 | A health check response will be considered valid if the |
Willy Tarreau | bd74154 | 2010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2349 | response's body contains this exact string. If the |
| 2350 | "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response |
| 2351 | will be considered invalid if the body contains this |
| 2352 | string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at |
| 2353 | the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a |
| 2354 | specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack |
| 2355 | trace). |
| 2356 | |
| 2357 | rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body. |
Jamie Gloudon | aaa2100 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 2358 | A health check response will be considered valid if the |
Willy Tarreau | bd74154 | 2010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2359 | response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring" |
| 2360 | keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be |
| 2361 | considered invalid if the body matches the expression. |
| 2362 | This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end |
| 2363 | of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific |
| 2364 | error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace). |
| 2365 | |
| 2366 | It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size |
| 2367 | defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes. |
| 2368 | Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using |
| 2369 | "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is |
| 2370 | possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable. |
| 2371 | However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can |
| 2372 | waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that |
| 2373 | it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. |
| 2374 | |
| 2375 | Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404", |
| 2376 | then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404. |
| 2377 | |
| 2378 | Examples : |
| 2379 | # only accept status 200 as valid |
Willy Tarreau | 8f2a1e7 | 2011-01-06 16:36:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2380 | http-check expect status 200 |
Willy Tarreau | bd74154 | 2010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2381 | |
| 2382 | # consider SQL errors as errors |
Willy Tarreau | 8f2a1e7 | 2011-01-06 16:36:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2383 | http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error |
Willy Tarreau | bd74154 | 2010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2384 | |
| 2385 | # consider status 5xx only as errors |
Willy Tarreau | 8f2a1e7 | 2011-01-06 16:36:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2386 | http-check expect ! rstatus ^5 |
Willy Tarreau | bd74154 | 2010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2387 | |
| 2388 | # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html |
Willy Tarreau | 8f2a1e7 | 2011-01-06 16:36:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2389 | http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html> |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2390 | |
Willy Tarreau | bd74154 | 2010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2391 | See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2392 | |
| 2393 | |
Willy Tarreau | ef78104 | 2010-01-27 11:53:01 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2394 | http-check send-state |
| 2395 | Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks |
| 2396 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2397 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 2398 | Arguments : none |
| 2399 | |
| 2400 | When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header |
| 2401 | "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server |
| 2402 | how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is |
| 2403 | manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether |
| 2404 | haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm. |
| 2405 | |
| 2406 | The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which |
| 2407 | is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid |
| 2408 | checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats |
| 2409 | interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in |
| 2410 | no specific order some values available in the stats interface : |
| 2411 | - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash |
| 2412 | ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is |
| 2413 | checked in multiple backends. |
| 2414 | |
| 2415 | - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the |
| 2416 | global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified. |
| 2417 | |
| 2418 | - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/") |
| 2419 | and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This |
| 2420 | helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this |
| 2421 | one fails. |
| 2422 | |
| 2423 | - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections |
| 2424 | on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of |
| 2425 | connections on all servers of the same backend. |
| 2426 | |
| 2427 | - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the |
| 2428 | server's queue. |
| 2429 | |
| 2430 | Example of a header received by the application server : |
| 2431 | >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \ |
| 2432 | scur=13/22; qcur=0 |
| 2433 | |
| 2434 | See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" |
| 2435 | |
Cyril Bonté | 2be1b3f | 2010-09-30 23:46:30 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2436 | http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] } |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2437 | [ { if | unless } <condition> ] |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2438 | Access control for Layer 7 requests |
| 2439 | |
| 2440 | May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2441 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 2442 | |
| 2443 | These set of options allow to fine control access to a |
| 2444 | frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl. |
| 2445 | First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final. |
Cyril Bonté | 2be1b3f | 2010-09-30 23:46:30 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2446 | For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is |
| 2447 | performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2448 | should be asked to enter a username and password. |
| 2449 | |
| 2450 | There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per |
| 2451 | instance. |
| 2452 | |
| 2453 | Example: |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2454 | acl nagios src 192.168.129.3 |
| 2455 | acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16 |
| 2456 | acl auth_ok http_auth(L1) |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2457 | |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2458 | http-request allow if nagios |
| 2459 | http-request allow if local_net auth_ok |
| 2460 | http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok |
| 2461 | http-request deny |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2462 | |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2463 | Example: |
| 2464 | acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1 |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2465 | |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2466 | http-request auth unless auth_ok |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2467 | |
Cyril Bonté | 2be1b3f | 2010-09-30 23:46:30 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2468 | See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 |
| 2469 | about ACL usage. |
Willy Tarreau | ef78104 | 2010-01-27 11:53:01 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2470 | |
Mark Lamourine | c2247f0 | 2012-01-04 13:02:01 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 2471 | http-send-name-header [<header>] |
| 2472 | Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header> |
| 2473 | |
| 2474 | May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2475 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 2476 | |
| 2477 | Arguments : |
| 2478 | |
| 2479 | <header> The header string to use to send the server name |
| 2480 | |
| 2481 | The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target |
| 2482 | server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name |
| 2483 | is added with the header string proved. |
| 2484 | |
| 2485 | See also : "server" |
| 2486 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f58a962 | 2008-02-23 01:19:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2487 | id <value> |
Willy Tarreau | 53fb4ae | 2009-10-04 23:04:08 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2488 | Set a persistent ID to a proxy. |
| 2489 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2490 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 2491 | Arguments : none |
| 2492 | |
| 2493 | Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive. |
| 2494 | An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned |
| 2495 | value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics. |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f58a962 | 2008-02-23 01:19:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2496 | |
| 2497 | |
Cyril Bonté | 0d4bf01 | 2010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2498 | ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition> |
| 2499 | Declare a condition to ignore persistence |
| 2500 | May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2501 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 2502 | |
| 2503 | By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing |
| 2504 | the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up |
| 2505 | and running). |
| 2506 | |
| 2507 | The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based |
| 2508 | conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence. |
| 2509 | This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which |
| 2510 | oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable |
| 2511 | persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots). |
| 2512 | |
| 2513 | Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as |
| 2514 | the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored. |
| 2515 | |
| 2516 | The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an |
| 2517 | "unless" condition is met. |
| 2518 | |
| 2519 | See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage. |
| 2520 | |
| 2521 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2522 | log global |
Willy Tarreau | f7edefa | 2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2523 | log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]] |
William Lallemand | 0f99e34 | 2011-10-12 17:50:54 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2524 | no log |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2525 | Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic. |
| 2526 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2527 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
William Lallemand | 0f99e34 | 2011-10-12 17:50:54 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2528 | |
| 2529 | Prefix : |
| 2530 | no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example, |
| 2531 | if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This |
| 2532 | prefix does not allow arguments. |
| 2533 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2534 | Arguments : |
| 2535 | global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the |
| 2536 | same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global" |
| 2537 | replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log |
| 2538 | entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global" |
| 2539 | statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other |
| 2540 | parameter. |
| 2541 | |
| 2542 | <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as |
| 2543 | for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of : |
| 2544 | |
| 2545 | - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP |
| 2546 | port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the |
| 2547 | standard syslog port). |
| 2548 | |
David du Colombier | 24bb5f5 | 2011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2549 | - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP |
| 2550 | port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the |
| 2551 | standard syslog port). |
| 2552 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2553 | - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind |
| 2554 | considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible |
| 2555 | inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is |
| 2556 | appropriately writeable). |
| 2557 | |
| 2558 | <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities : |
| 2559 | |
| 2560 | kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news |
| 2561 | uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2 |
| 2562 | local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7 |
| 2563 | |
| 2564 | <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By |
| 2565 | default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only |
| 2566 | messages with a severity at least as important as this level |
Willy Tarreau | f7edefa | 2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2567 | will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it |
| 2568 | is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will |
| 2569 | be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg" |
| 2570 | messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations. |
| 2571 | Eight levels are known : |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2572 | |
| 2573 | emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug |
| 2574 | |
William Lallemand | 0f99e34 | 2011-10-12 17:50:54 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2575 | It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to |
| 2576 | log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries |
| 2577 | from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info". |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2578 | |
| 2579 | However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes |
| 2580 | will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up, |
| 2581 | "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service |
| 2582 | termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down. |
| 2583 | |
| 2584 | Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before |
| 2585 | being emitted. |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2586 | |
| 2587 | Example : |
| 2588 | log global |
Willy Tarreau | f7edefa | 2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2589 | log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events |
| 2590 | log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2591 | |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2592 | log-format <string> |
| 2593 | Allows you to custom a log line. |
| 2594 | |
| 2595 | See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4) |
| 2596 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2597 | |
| 2598 | maxconn <conns> |
| 2599 | Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend |
| 2600 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2601 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 2602 | Arguments : |
| 2603 | <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will |
| 2604 | accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system |
| 2605 | in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection |
| 2606 | closes. |
| 2607 | |
| 2608 | If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit |
| 2609 | very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the |
| 2610 | clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the |
| 2611 | global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers |
| 2612 | of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being |
| 2613 | consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped |
| 2614 | with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if |
| 2615 | properly tuned. |
| 2616 | |
| 2617 | Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers |
| 2618 | are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise |
| 2619 | to assign them some reasonable connection limits. |
| 2620 | |
Vincent Bernat | 6341be5 | 2012-06-27 17:18:30 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2621 | By default, this value is set to 2000. |
| 2622 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2623 | See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn" |
| 2624 | |
| 2625 | |
| 2626 | mode { tcp|http|health } |
| 2627 | Set the running mode or protocol of the instance |
| 2628 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2629 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 2630 | Arguments : |
| 2631 | tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection |
| 2632 | will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7 |
| 2633 | examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It |
| 2634 | should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ... |
| 2635 | |
| 2636 | http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be |
| 2637 | analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request |
| 2638 | which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering, |
| 2639 | processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which |
| 2640 | brings HAProxy most of its value. |
| 2641 | |
| 2642 | health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK" |
Willy Tarreau | 82569f9 | 2012-09-27 23:48:56 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2643 | to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively, |
| 2644 | If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent |
| 2645 | instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used |
| 2646 | to reply to external components health checks. This mode is |
| 2647 | deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do |
| 2648 | the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the |
| 2649 | "monitor" keyword. |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2650 | |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2651 | When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the |
| 2652 | backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration |
| 2653 | will be refused. |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2654 | |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2655 | Example : |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2656 | defaults http_instances |
| 2657 | mode http |
| 2658 | |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2659 | See also : "monitor", "monitor-net" |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2660 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2661 | |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2662 | monitor fail { if | unless } <condition> |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2663 | Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2664 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2665 | no | yes | yes | no |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2666 | Arguments : |
| 2667 | if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied, |
| 2668 | and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2669 | combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2670 | are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a |
| 2671 | backend and its backup. |
| 2672 | |
| 2673 | unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is |
| 2674 | satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be |
| 2675 | based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active |
| 2676 | servers in a list of backends. |
| 2677 | |
| 2678 | This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor |
| 2679 | request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries |
| 2680 | the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the |
| 2681 | conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is |
| 2682 | very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base |
| 2683 | routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by |
| 2684 | haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv" |
Willy Tarreau | ae94d4d | 2011-05-11 16:28:49 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2685 | criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status |
| 2686 | messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2687 | |
| 2688 | Example: |
| 2689 | frontend www |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2690 | mode http |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2691 | acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 |
| 2692 | acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2 |
| 2693 | monitor-uri /site_alive |
| 2694 | monitor fail if site_dead |
| 2695 | |
Willy Tarreau | ae94d4d | 2011-05-11 16:28:49 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2696 | See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc" |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2697 | |
| 2698 | |
| 2699 | monitor-net <source> |
| 2700 | Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests |
| 2701 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2702 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 2703 | Arguments : |
| 2704 | <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to |
| 2705 | get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4 |
| 2706 | address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/') |
| 2707 | followed by a mask. |
| 2708 | |
| 2709 | In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause |
| 2710 | the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2711 | equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2712 | forwarding the connection to a remote server. |
| 2713 | |
| 2714 | In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be |
| 2715 | accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request, |
| 2716 | then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally |
| 2717 | enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and |
Willy Tarreau | 82569f9 | 2012-09-27 23:48:56 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2718 | running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this |
| 2719 | response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important |
| 2720 | as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners. |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2721 | |
Willy Tarreau | 82569f9 | 2012-09-27 23:48:56 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2722 | Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection |
| 2723 | ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short |
| 2724 | lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and |
| 2725 | it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to |
| 2726 | an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do |
| 2727 | not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net". |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2728 | |
Willy Tarreau | 95cd283 | 2010-03-04 23:36:33 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2729 | Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in |
| 2730 | a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered. |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2731 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2769aa0 | 2007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2732 | Example : |
| 2733 | # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us. |
| 2734 | frontend www |
| 2735 | monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31 |
| 2736 | |
| 2737 | See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri" |
| 2738 | |
| 2739 | |
| 2740 | monitor-uri <uri> |
| 2741 | Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests |
| 2742 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2743 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 2744 | Arguments : |
| 2745 | <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's |
| 2746 | health status instead of forwarding the request. |
| 2747 | |
| 2748 | When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend, |
| 2749 | HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either |
| 2750 | "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure |
| 2751 | conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any |
| 2752 | front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without |
| 2753 | forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the |
| 2754 | version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid |
| 2755 | at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend. |
| 2756 | |
| 2757 | Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor |
| 2758 | divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended |
| 2759 | purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component, |
| 2760 | nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using |
| 2761 | "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check |
| 2762 | can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend). |
| 2763 | |
| 2764 | Example : |
| 2765 | # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status |
| 2766 | frontend www |
| 2767 | mode http |
| 2768 | monitor-uri /haproxy_test |
| 2769 | |
| 2770 | See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net" |
| 2771 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2772 | |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2773 | option abortonclose |
| 2774 | no option abortonclose |
| 2775 | Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues. |
| 2776 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2777 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 2778 | Arguments : none |
| 2779 | |
| 2780 | In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond. |
| 2781 | The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will |
| 2782 | increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session |
| 2783 | response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will |
Willy Tarreau | 198a744 | 2008-01-17 12:05:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2784 | often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2785 | the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the |
| 2786 | request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error |
| 2787 | encountered while delivering the response. |
| 2788 | |
| 2789 | As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output |
| 2790 | close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider |
| 2791 | that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for |
| 2792 | the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users |
| 2793 | do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at |
| 2794 | all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2795 | support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2796 | hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel |
Willy Tarreau | 198a744 | 2008-01-17 12:05:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2797 | to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2798 | of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely |
| 2799 | low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while |
| 2800 | still not served and not pollute the servers. |
| 2801 | |
| 2802 | In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option |
| 2803 | "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP |
| 2804 | compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is |
| 2805 | specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while |
| 2806 | it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or |
| 2807 | during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged |
| 2808 | the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load |
| 2809 | on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2810 | reduces the response time for other users. |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2811 | |
| 2812 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 2813 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 2814 | |
| 2815 | See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters |
| 2816 | |
| 2817 | |
Willy Tarreau | 4076a15 | 2009-04-02 15:18:36 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2818 | option accept-invalid-http-request |
| 2819 | no option accept-invalid-http-request |
| 2820 | Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing |
| 2821 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2822 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 2823 | Arguments : none |
| 2824 | |
| 2825 | By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This |
| 2826 | means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an |
| 2827 | error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such |
| 2828 | forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server |
| 2829 | weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or |
| 2830 | server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration, |
| 2831 | implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case, |
| 2832 | it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character |
Willy Tarreau | 422246e | 2012-01-07 23:54:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2833 | even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the |
| 2834 | list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and |
| 2835 | chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96 |
| 2836 | ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are |
| 2837 | not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The |
| 2838 | remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. |
Willy Tarreau | 4076a15 | 2009-04-02 15:18:36 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2839 | |
| 2840 | This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs |
| 2841 | and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has |
| 2842 | been confirmed. |
| 2843 | |
| 2844 | When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in |
| 2845 | requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later |
Willy Tarreau | 422246e | 2012-01-07 23:54:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2846 | analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly, |
| 2847 | requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this |
Willy Tarreau | 4076a15 | 2009-04-02 15:18:36 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2848 | also helps confirming that the issue has been solved. |
| 2849 | |
| 2850 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 2851 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 2852 | |
| 2853 | See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the |
| 2854 | stats socket. |
| 2855 | |
| 2856 | |
| 2857 | option accept-invalid-http-response |
| 2858 | no option accept-invalid-http-response |
| 2859 | Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing |
| 2860 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2861 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 2862 | Arguments : none |
| 2863 | |
| 2864 | By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This |
| 2865 | means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an |
| 2866 | error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such |
| 2867 | forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server |
| 2868 | weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or |
| 2869 | server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration, |
| 2870 | implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case, |
| 2871 | it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character |
| 2872 | even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. |
| 2873 | |
| 2874 | This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs |
| 2875 | and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has |
| 2876 | been confirmed. |
| 2877 | |
| 2878 | When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in |
| 2879 | responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit |
| 2880 | later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. |
| 2881 | Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved. |
| 2882 | |
| 2883 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 2884 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 2885 | |
| 2886 | See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the |
| 2887 | stats socket. |
| 2888 | |
| 2889 | |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2890 | option allbackups |
| 2891 | no option allbackups |
| 2892 | Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one |
| 2893 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2894 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 2895 | Arguments : none |
| 2896 | |
| 2897 | By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal |
| 2898 | servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups |
| 2899 | at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled, |
| 2900 | the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal |
| 2901 | ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the |
| 2902 | servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority |
| 2903 | order between the backup servers anymore. |
| 2904 | |
| 2905 | This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a |
| 2906 | "sorry" page when an application is completely offline. |
| 2907 | |
| 2908 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 2909 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 2910 | |
| 2911 | |
| 2912 | option checkcache |
| 2913 | no option checkcache |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2914 | Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2915 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2916 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 2917 | Arguments : none |
| 2918 | |
| 2919 | Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not |
| 2920 | always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2921 | be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2922 | high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same |
| 2923 | caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let |
Willy Tarreau | 3c92c5f | 2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 2924 | some sensitive session information go in the wild. |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2925 | |
| 2926 | The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2927 | strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It |
Willy Tarreau | 198a744 | 2008-01-17 12:05:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2928 | carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2929 | response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side |
| 2930 | proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered |
Willy Tarreau | 198a744 | 2008-01-17 12:05:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2931 | to the client are : |
| 2932 | - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ; |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2933 | - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410, |
Willy Tarreau | 198a744 | 2008-01-17 12:05:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2934 | provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ; |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2935 | - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not |
| 2936 | set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ; |
| 2937 | - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header |
| 2938 | - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header |
| 2939 | - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header |
| 2940 | - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header |
| 2941 | - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header |
| 2942 | - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header |
| 2943 | - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header |
| 2944 | - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header |
| 2945 | (allowing other fields after set-cookie) |
| 2946 | |
| 2947 | If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked |
Willy Tarreau | 198a744 | 2008-01-17 12:05:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2948 | just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway". |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2949 | The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2950 | during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2951 | that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed. |
| 2952 | |
| 2953 | Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested |
| 2954 | in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2955 | good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2956 | production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours. |
| 2957 | |
| 2958 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 2959 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 2960 | |
| 2961 | |
| 2962 | option clitcpka |
| 2963 | no option clitcpka |
| 2964 | Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side |
| 2965 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 2966 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 2967 | Arguments : none |
| 2968 | |
| 2969 | When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and |
| 2970 | a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle |
| 2971 | periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate |
| 2972 | components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long. |
| 2973 | |
| 2974 | Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets |
| 2975 | to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between |
| 2976 | keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the |
| 2977 | operating system and its tuning parameters. |
| 2978 | |
| 2979 | It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor |
| 2980 | received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees |
| 2981 | them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives |
| 2982 | to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be |
| 2983 | forwarded to the other side of the proxy. |
| 2984 | |
| 2985 | Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive. |
| 2986 | |
| 2987 | Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the |
| 2988 | client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are |
| 2989 | noticed between HAProxy and a client. |
| 2990 | |
| 2991 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 2992 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 2993 | |
| 2994 | See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka" |
| 2995 | |
| 2996 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 2997 | option contstats |
| 2998 | Enable continuous traffic statistics updates |
| 2999 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3000 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 3001 | Arguments : none |
| 3002 | |
| 3003 | By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented |
| 3004 | only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small |
| 3005 | objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or |
| 3006 | with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like |
| 3007 | a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously, |
| 3008 | during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so |
| 3009 | it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%). |
| 3010 | |
| 3011 | |
Willy Tarreau | c9bd0cc | 2009-05-10 11:57:02 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3012 | option dontlog-normal |
| 3013 | no option dontlog-normal |
| 3014 | Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections |
| 3015 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3016 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 3017 | Arguments : none |
| 3018 | |
| 3019 | There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second |
| 3020 | and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn |
| 3021 | logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that |
| 3022 | normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor |
| 3023 | redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP |
| 3024 | mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be |
| 3025 | logged. |
| 3026 | |
| 3027 | It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to |
| 3028 | complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you |
| 3029 | need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead. |
| 3030 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3031 | See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about |
Willy Tarreau | c9bd0cc | 2009-05-10 11:57:02 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3032 | logging. |
| 3033 | |
| 3034 | |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3035 | option dontlognull |
| 3036 | no option dontlognull |
| 3037 | Enable or disable logging of null connections |
| 3038 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3039 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 3040 | Arguments : none |
| 3041 | |
| 3042 | In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to |
| 3043 | various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from |
| 3044 | another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a |
| 3045 | simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute |
| 3046 | the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate |
| 3047 | that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged, |
| 3048 | which typically corresponds to those probes. |
| 3049 | |
| 3050 | It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled |
| 3051 | environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities |
| 3052 | would not be logged. |
| 3053 | |
| 3054 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3055 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3056 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3057 | See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging. |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3058 | |
| 3059 | |
| 3060 | option forceclose |
| 3061 | no option forceclose |
| 3062 | Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred. |
| 3063 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
Willy Tarreau | a31e5df | 2009-12-30 01:10:35 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3064 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3065 | Arguments : none |
| 3066 | |
| 3067 | Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive |
| 3068 | the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not |
| 3069 | close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This |
| 3070 | causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high |
| 3071 | global session times in the logs. |
| 3072 | |
| 3073 | When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will |
Willy Tarreau | 82eeaf2 | 2009-12-29 12:09:05 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3074 | actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished |
Willy Tarreau | 0dfdf19 | 2010-01-05 11:33:11 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3075 | to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that |
| 3076 | this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which |
| 3077 | means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some |
| 3078 | resources earlier than with httpclose. |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3079 | |
Willy Tarreau | 8a8e1d9 | 2010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3080 | This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which |
| 3081 | will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause |
| 3082 | the connection to be closed once the whole response is received. |
| 3083 | |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3084 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3085 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3086 | |
Willy Tarreau | 8a8e1d9 | 2010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3087 | See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive" |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3088 | |
| 3089 | |
Willy Tarreau | 87cf514 | 2011-08-19 22:57:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3090 | option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ] |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3091 | Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers |
| 3092 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3093 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 3094 | Arguments : |
| 3095 | <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources |
| 3096 | matching <network> |
Ross West | af72a1d | 2008-08-03 10:51:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3097 | <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For" |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3098 | header name. |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3099 | |
| 3100 | Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as |
| 3101 | their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address |
| 3102 | is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header |
| 3103 | "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. |
| 3104 | This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this |
| 3105 | header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server |
| 3106 | must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See |
Ross West | af72a1d | 2008-08-03 10:51:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3107 | the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note |
| 3108 | that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really |
| 3109 | possible that the client has already brought one. |
| 3110 | |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3111 | The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace |
Ross West | af72a1d | 2008-08-03 10:51:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3112 | the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3113 | have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel), |
| 3114 | and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the |
Ross West | af72a1d | 2008-08-03 10:51:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3115 | "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers |
| 3116 | require "X-Cluster-Client-IP"). |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3117 | |
| 3118 | Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client |
| 3119 | access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is |
| 3120 | used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the |
| 3121 | header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword |
| 3122 | followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the |
| 3123 | network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with |
| 3124 | private networks or 127.0.0.1. |
| 3125 | |
Willy Tarreau | 87cf514 | 2011-08-19 22:57:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3126 | Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be |
| 3127 | added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted |
| 3128 | environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy |
| 3129 | are under the control of the end-user. |
| 3130 | |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3131 | This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at |
Ross West | af72a1d | 2008-08-03 10:51:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3132 | least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's |
| 3133 | setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if |
Willy Tarreau | 87cf514 | 2011-08-19 22:57:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3134 | both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of |
| 3135 | the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be |
| 3136 | mandatory, so it wins. |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3137 | |
Willy Tarreau | 87cf514 | 2011-08-19 22:57:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3138 | It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and |
| 3139 | only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first |
| 3140 | request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want. |
| 3141 | In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or |
| 3142 | "http-server-close" options is set when using this option. |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3143 | |
Ross West | af72a1d | 2008-08-03 10:51:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3144 | Examples : |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3145 | # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine |
| 3146 | frontend www |
| 3147 | mode http |
| 3148 | option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header |
| 3149 | |
Ross West | af72a1d | 2008-08-03 10:51:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3150 | # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client |
| 3151 | backend www |
| 3152 | mode http |
| 3153 | option forwardfor header X-Client |
| 3154 | |
Willy Tarreau | 87cf514 | 2011-08-19 22:57:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3155 | See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", |
| 3156 | "option forceclose" |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3157 | |
Willy Tarreau | 8a8e1d9 | 2010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3158 | |
Willy Tarreau | 96e3121 | 2011-05-30 18:10:30 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3159 | option http-no-delay |
| 3160 | no option http-no-delay |
| 3161 | Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP |
| 3162 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3163 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 3164 | Arguments : none |
| 3165 | |
| 3166 | In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity. |
| 3167 | Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay. |
| 3168 | There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP |
| 3169 | protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many |
| 3170 | interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is |
| 3171 | absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across |
| 3172 | most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through |
| 3173 | haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network |
| 3174 | optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for |
| 3175 | enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical |
| 3176 | delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with |
| 3177 | abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not |
| 3178 | affected. |
| 3179 | |
| 3180 | When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend |
| 3181 | used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to |
| 3182 | make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on |
| 3183 | the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via |
| 3184 | HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used |
| 3185 | by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application |
| 3186 | is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth |
| 3187 | usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high |
| 3188 | latency environments. |
| 3189 | |
| 3190 | |
Willy Tarreau | 8a8e1d9 | 2010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3191 | option http-pretend-keepalive |
| 3192 | no option http-pretend-keepalive |
| 3193 | Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not |
| 3194 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3195 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 3196 | Arguments : none |
| 3197 | |
| 3198 | When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy |
| 3199 | adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server. |
| 3200 | Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain |
| 3201 | from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this |
| 3202 | is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from |
| 3203 | maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or |
| 3204 | a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and |
| 3205 | consider the response complete. |
| 3206 | |
| 3207 | By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server |
| 3208 | believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back |
| 3209 | to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it |
| 3210 | will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the |
| 3211 | "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the |
| 3212 | connection is correctly closed on the server side. |
| 3213 | |
| 3214 | It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers |
| 3215 | will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet, |
| 3216 | and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the |
| 3217 | network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is |
| 3218 | worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly |
| 3219 | less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture, |
| 3220 | enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles. |
| 3221 | |
| 3222 | This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if |
| 3223 | at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled. |
Jamie Gloudon | aaa2100 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 3224 | This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause |
Willy Tarreau | 22a9534 | 2010-09-29 14:31:41 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3225 | keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the |
| 3226 | client. This practice is discouraged though. |
Willy Tarreau | 8a8e1d9 | 2010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3227 | |
| 3228 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3229 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3230 | |
| 3231 | See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close" |
| 3232 | |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3233 | |
Willy Tarreau | b608feb | 2010-01-02 22:47:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3234 | option http-server-close |
| 3235 | no option http-server-close |
| 3236 | Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side |
| 3237 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3238 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 3239 | Arguments : none |
| 3240 | |
Patrick Mezard | 9ec2ec4 | 2010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3241 | By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only |
| 3242 | analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting |
| 3243 | "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server |
| 3244 | side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on |
| 3245 | the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow |
| 3246 | network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server |
| 3247 | resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive |
| 3248 | capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they |
| 3249 | conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not |
| 3250 | always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the |
| 3251 | request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround |
| 3252 | consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive". |
Willy Tarreau | b608feb | 2010-01-02 22:47:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3253 | |
| 3254 | At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same |
| 3255 | session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end |
| 3256 | of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent |
| 3257 | waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the |
Willy Tarreau | b16a574 | 2010-01-10 14:46:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3258 | timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if |
| 3259 | not set. |
Willy Tarreau | b608feb | 2010-01-02 22:47:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3260 | |
| 3261 | This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if |
| 3262 | at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled. |
Willy Tarreau | 0dfdf19 | 2010-01-05 11:33:11 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3263 | It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option |
| 3264 | http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose" |
| 3265 | basically achieve the same result as "forceclose". |
Willy Tarreau | b608feb | 2010-01-02 22:47:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3266 | |
| 3267 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3268 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3269 | |
Patrick Mezard | 9ec2ec4 | 2010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3270 | See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive", |
| 3271 | "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model". |
Willy Tarreau | b608feb | 2010-01-02 22:47:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3272 | |
| 3273 | |
Willy Tarreau | 88d349d | 2010-01-25 12:15:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3274 | option http-use-proxy-header |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3275 | no option http-use-proxy-header |
Willy Tarreau | 88d349d | 2010-01-25 12:15:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3276 | Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection |
| 3277 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3278 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 3279 | Arguments : none |
| 3280 | |
| 3281 | While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the |
| 3282 | Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent |
| 3283 | connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied |
| 3284 | connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection |
| 3285 | header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between |
| 3286 | browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what |
| 3287 | haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on. |
| 3288 | |
| 3289 | By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use |
| 3290 | that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is |
| 3291 | defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The |
| 3292 | choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of |
| 3293 | one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note |
| 3294 | that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the |
| 3295 | request along its whole life. |
| 3296 | |
Willy Tarreau | 844a7e7 | 2010-01-31 21:46:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3297 | Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will |
| 3298 | automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a |
| 3299 | proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in |
| 3300 | front of an existing proxy. |
| 3301 | |
Willy Tarreau | 88d349d | 2010-01-25 12:15:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3302 | This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy. |
| 3303 | |
| 3304 | See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option |
| 3305 | http-server-close". |
| 3306 | |
| 3307 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3308 | option httpchk |
| 3309 | option httpchk <uri> |
| 3310 | option httpchk <method> <uri> |
| 3311 | option httpchk <method> <uri> <version> |
| 3312 | Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health |
| 3313 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3314 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 3315 | Arguments : |
| 3316 | <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set, |
| 3317 | the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server |
| 3318 | processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method |
| 3319 | may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard |
| 3320 | ones. |
| 3321 | |
| 3322 | <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / " |
| 3323 | which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be |
| 3324 | changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted. |
| 3325 | |
| 3326 | <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0" |
| 3327 | but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning |
| 3328 | it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is |
| 3329 | mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it |
| 3330 | after "\r\n" following the version string. |
| 3331 | |
| 3332 | By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP |
| 3333 | connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is |
| 3334 | sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are |
| 3335 | considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including |
| 3336 | the lack of any response. |
| 3337 | |
| 3338 | The port and interval are specified in the server configuration. |
| 3339 | |
| 3340 | This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with |
| 3341 | plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound |
| 3342 | to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. |
| 3343 | |
| 3344 | Examples : |
| 3345 | # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability |
| 3346 | # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80. |
| 3347 | backend https_relay |
| 3348 | mode tcp |
| 3349 | option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www |
| 3350 | server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80 |
| 3351 | |
| 3352 | See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check", |
Rauf Kuliyev | 38b4156 | 2011-01-04 15:14:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3353 | "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and |
| 3354 | "inter" server options. |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3355 | |
| 3356 | |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3357 | option httpclose |
| 3358 | no option httpclose |
| 3359 | Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing |
| 3360 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3361 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 3362 | Arguments : none |
| 3363 | |
Patrick Mezard | 9ec2ec4 | 2010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3364 | By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only |
| 3365 | analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option |
| 3366 | httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already |
| 3367 | set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to |
| 3368 | this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus |
| 3369 | resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header |
| 3370 | different from "close" will also be removed. |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3371 | |
| 3372 | It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not |
Jamie Gloudon | aaa2100 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 3373 | close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this |
Willy Tarreau | 0dfdf19 | 2010-01-05 11:33:11 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3374 | reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens |
| 3375 | it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the |
| 3376 | request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also |
| 3377 | releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for |
| 3378 | the client to acknowledge it. |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3379 | |
| 3380 | This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if |
| 3381 | at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled. |
| 3382 | If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose". |
Willy Tarreau | 0dfdf19 | 2010-01-05 11:33:11 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3383 | If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it |
| 3384 | basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose". |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3385 | |
| 3386 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3387 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3388 | |
Patrick Mezard | 9ec2ec4 | 2010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3389 | See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and |
| 3390 | "1.1. The HTTP transaction model". |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3391 | |
| 3392 | |
Emeric Brun | 3a058f3 | 2009-06-30 18:26:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3393 | option httplog [ clf ] |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3394 | Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers |
| 3395 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3396 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
Emeric Brun | 3a058f3 | 2009-06-30 18:26:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3397 | Arguments : |
| 3398 | clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be |
| 3399 | the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can |
| 3400 | use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific |
| 3401 | log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not |
| 3402 | extensible. |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3403 | |
| 3404 | By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the |
| 3405 | source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying |
| 3406 | "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, |
| 3407 | but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session |
| 3408 | status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the |
| 3409 | frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and |
| 3410 | ports. |
| 3411 | |
| 3412 | This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend. |
| 3413 | |
Emeric Brun | 3a058f3 | 2009-06-30 18:26:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3414 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3415 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying |
| 3416 | only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set |
| 3417 | by default. |
| 3418 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3419 | See also : section 8 about logging. |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3420 | |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3421 | |
| 3422 | option http_proxy |
| 3423 | no option http_proxy |
| 3424 | Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode |
| 3425 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3426 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 3427 | Arguments : none |
| 3428 | |
| 3429 | It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands |
| 3430 | basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case, |
| 3431 | it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy" |
| 3432 | set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to |
| 3433 | the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme. |
| 3434 | |
| 3435 | No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP |
| 3436 | addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited, |
| 3437 | it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last, |
| 3438 | if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be |
Cyril Bonté | 2409e68 | 2010-12-14 22:47:51 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3439 | needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3440 | be analyzed. |
| 3441 | |
| 3442 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3443 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3444 | |
| 3445 | Example : |
| 3446 | # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly. |
| 3447 | backend direct_forward |
| 3448 | option httpclose |
| 3449 | option http_proxy |
| 3450 | |
| 3451 | See also : "option httpclose" |
| 3452 | |
Willy Tarreau | 211ad24 | 2009-10-03 21:45:07 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3453 | |
Jamie Gloudon | 801a0a3 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 3454 | option independent-streams |
| 3455 | no option independent-streams |
| 3456 | Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions |
Willy Tarreau | f27b5ea | 2009-10-03 22:01:18 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3457 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3458 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 3459 | Arguments : none |
| 3460 | |
| 3461 | By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the |
| 3462 | read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is |
| 3463 | activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should |
| 3464 | receive data or not. |
| 3465 | |
| 3466 | While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there |
| 3467 | exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the |
| 3468 | read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large |
| 3469 | timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the |
| 3470 | server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's |
| 3471 | socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way |
| 3472 | to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when |
| 3473 | the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself |
| 3474 | to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not |
| 3475 | happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the |
| 3476 | socket buffers. |
| 3477 | |
| 3478 | When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates |
| 3479 | on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When |
| 3480 | the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on |
| 3481 | data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from |
| 3482 | slow lines, so use it with caution. |
| 3483 | |
Jamie Gloudon | 801a0a3 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 3484 | Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams" |
| 3485 | with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but |
| 3486 | deprecated. |
| 3487 | |
Willy Tarreau | ce887fd | 2012-05-12 12:50:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3488 | See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel" |
Willy Tarreau | f27b5ea | 2009-10-03 22:01:18 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3489 | |
| 3490 | |
Gabor Lekeny | b4c81e4 | 2010-09-29 18:17:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3491 | option ldap-check |
| 3492 | Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing |
| 3493 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3494 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 3495 | Arguments : none |
| 3496 | |
| 3497 | It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just |
| 3498 | testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an |
| 3499 | LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response |
| 3500 | is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message. |
| 3501 | |
| 3502 | The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success |
| 3503 | resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9). |
| 3504 | |
| 3505 | Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to |
| 3506 | configure it. |
| 3507 | |
| 3508 | Example : |
| 3509 | option ldap-check |
| 3510 | |
| 3511 | See also : "option httpchk" |
| 3512 | |
| 3513 | |
Willy Tarreau | 211ad24 | 2009-10-03 21:45:07 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3514 | option log-health-checks |
| 3515 | no option log-health-checks |
| 3516 | Enable or disable logging of health checks |
| 3517 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3518 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 3519 | Arguments : none |
| 3520 | |
| 3521 | Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what |
| 3522 | was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if |
| 3523 | server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount |
| 3524 | of additional information is limited. |
| 3525 | |
| 3526 | If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed |
| 3527 | when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED. |
| 3528 | |
| 3529 | See also: "log" and section 8 about logging. |
| 3530 | |
Willy Tarreau | c9bd0cc | 2009-05-10 11:57:02 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3531 | |
| 3532 | option log-separate-errors |
| 3533 | no option log-separate-errors |
| 3534 | Change log level for non-completely successful connections |
| 3535 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3536 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 3537 | Arguments : none |
| 3538 | |
| 3539 | Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy |
| 3540 | raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such |
| 3541 | as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The |
| 3542 | level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them |
| 3543 | separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to |
| 3544 | remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which |
| 3545 | provides very important information. |
| 3546 | |
| 3547 | Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per |
| 3548 | second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller |
| 3549 | error logs. |
| 3550 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3551 | See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about |
Willy Tarreau | c9bd0cc | 2009-05-10 11:57:02 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3552 | logging. |
| 3553 | |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3554 | |
| 3555 | option logasap |
| 3556 | no option logasap |
| 3557 | Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests |
| 3558 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3559 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 3560 | Arguments : none |
| 3561 | |
| 3562 | By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total |
| 3563 | transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects |
| 3564 | are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the |
| 3565 | logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server |
| 3566 | sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be |
| 3567 | the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount |
| 3568 | of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3569 | time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3570 | "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many |
| 3571 | bytes are expected to be transferred. |
| 3572 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3573 | Examples : |
| 3574 | listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80 |
| 3575 | mode http |
| 3576 | option httplog |
| 3577 | option logasap |
| 3578 | log 192.168.2.200 local3 |
| 3579 | |
| 3580 | >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \ |
| 3581 | haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \ |
| 3582 | static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \ |
| 3583 | "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0" |
| 3584 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3585 | See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about |
Willy Tarreau | c27debf | 2008-01-06 08:57:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3586 | logging. |
| 3587 | |
| 3588 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | 8776f1b | 2010-10-18 15:58:36 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3589 | option mysql-check [ user <username> ] |
| 3590 | Use MySQL health checks for server testing |
Hervé COMMOWICK | 698ae00 | 2010-01-12 09:25:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3591 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3592 | yes | no | yes | yes |
Hervé COMMOWICK | 8776f1b | 2010-10-18 15:58:36 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3593 | Arguments : |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3594 | <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL |
| 3595 | server. |
Hervé COMMOWICK | 8776f1b | 2010-10-18 15:58:36 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3596 | |
| 3597 | If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet, |
| 3598 | one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close |
| 3599 | MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or |
| 3600 | Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor |
| 3601 | aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization |
| 3602 | in the MySQL table, like this : |
| 3603 | |
| 3604 | USE mysql; |
| 3605 | INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>'); |
| 3606 | FLUSH PRIVILEGES; |
| 3607 | |
| 3608 | If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the |
| 3609 | check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or |
| 3610 | Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it |
| 3611 | can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough |
| 3612 | traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors" |
| 3613 | value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL |
| 3614 | "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted, |
| 3615 | the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get |
| 3616 | blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it. |
| 3617 | |
| 3618 | Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency. |
| 3619 | To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example. |
Hervé COMMOWICK | 698ae00 | 2010-01-12 09:25:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3620 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | 212f778 | 2011-06-10 14:05:59 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3621 | The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check. |
Hervé COMMOWICK | 698ae00 | 2010-01-12 09:25:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3622 | |
| 3623 | Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for |
| 3624 | various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging. |
| 3625 | When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when |
| 3626 | connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, |
| 3627 | which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server |
| 3628 | to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy. |
| 3629 | |
| 3630 | See also: "option httpchk" |
| 3631 | |
Rauf Kuliyev | 38b4156 | 2011-01-04 15:14:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3632 | option pgsql-check [ user <username> ] |
| 3633 | Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing |
| 3634 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3635 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 3636 | Arguments : |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3637 | <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to |
| 3638 | PostgreSQL server. |
Rauf Kuliyev | 38b4156 | 2011-01-04 15:14:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3639 | |
| 3640 | The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either |
| 3641 | Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful |
| 3642 | test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server. |
| 3643 | This check is identical with the "mysql-check". |
| 3644 | |
| 3645 | See also: "option httpchk" |
Hervé COMMOWICK | 698ae00 | 2010-01-12 09:25:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3646 | |
Willy Tarreau | a453bdd | 2008-01-08 19:50:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3647 | option nolinger |
| 3648 | no option nolinger |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3649 | Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close |
Willy Tarreau | a453bdd | 2008-01-08 19:50:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3650 | May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3651 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3652 | Arguments : none |
Willy Tarreau | a453bdd | 2008-01-08 19:50:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3653 | |
| 3654 | When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are |
| 3655 | physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is |
| 3656 | closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system, |
| 3657 | using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer |
| 3658 | connections. |
| 3659 | |
| 3660 | When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces |
| 3661 | the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus, |
| 3662 | the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has |
| 3663 | side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits |
| 3664 | getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about |
| 3665 | this too. |
| 3666 | |
| 3667 | For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely |
| 3668 | needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1 |
| 3669 | sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count). |
| 3670 | |
| 3671 | This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side |
| 3672 | where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend |
| 3673 | for servers. |
| 3674 | |
| 3675 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3676 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3677 | |
| 3678 | |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3679 | option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] |
| 3680 | Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers |
| 3681 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3682 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 3683 | Arguments : |
| 3684 | <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources |
| 3685 | matching <network> |
| 3686 | <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To" |
| 3687 | header name. |
| 3688 | |
| 3689 | Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can |
| 3690 | be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a |
| 3691 | complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will |
| 3692 | be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip |
| 3693 | addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be |
| 3694 | added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a |
| 3695 | value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be |
| 3696 | configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that |
| 3697 | only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really |
| 3698 | possible that the client has already brought one. |
| 3699 | |
| 3700 | The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace |
| 3701 | the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already |
| 3702 | have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need |
| 3703 | preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To" |
| 3704 | header and requires different one. |
| 3705 | |
| 3706 | Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client |
| 3707 | access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is |
| 3708 | used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the |
| 3709 | header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword |
| 3710 | followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the |
| 3711 | network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with |
| 3712 | private networks or 127.0.0.1. |
| 3713 | |
| 3714 | This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at |
| 3715 | least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's |
| 3716 | setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if |
| 3717 | both are defined. |
| 3718 | |
Willy Tarreau | 87cf514 | 2011-08-19 22:57:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3719 | It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and |
| 3720 | only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first |
| 3721 | request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want. |
| 3722 | In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or |
| 3723 | "http-server-close" options is set when using this option. |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3724 | |
| 3725 | Examples : |
| 3726 | # Original Destination address |
| 3727 | frontend www |
| 3728 | mode http |
| 3729 | option originalto except 127.0.0.1 |
| 3730 | |
| 3731 | # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst |
| 3732 | backend www |
| 3733 | mode http |
| 3734 | option originalto header X-Client-Dst |
| 3735 | |
Willy Tarreau | 87cf514 | 2011-08-19 22:57:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3736 | See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", |
| 3737 | "option forceclose" |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3738 | |
| 3739 | |
Willy Tarreau | a453bdd | 2008-01-08 19:50:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3740 | option persist |
| 3741 | no option persist |
| 3742 | Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers |
| 3743 | May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3744 | yes | no | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3745 | Arguments : none |
Willy Tarreau | a453bdd | 2008-01-08 19:50:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3746 | |
| 3747 | When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead |
| 3748 | server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to |
| 3749 | force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist" |
| 3750 | if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme |
| 3751 | load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be |
| 3752 | directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be |
| 3753 | correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction |
| 3754 | with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to |
| 3755 | the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be |
| 3756 | redirected to another valid server. |
| 3757 | |
| 3758 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3759 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3760 | |
Willy Tarreau | 4de9149 | 2010-01-22 19:10:05 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3761 | See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist" |
Willy Tarreau | a453bdd | 2008-01-08 19:50:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3762 | |
| 3763 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 25b501a | 2008-01-06 16:36:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3764 | option redispatch |
| 3765 | no option redispatch |
| 3766 | Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure |
| 3767 | May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3768 | yes | no | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3769 | Arguments : none |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 25b501a | 2008-01-06 16:36:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3770 | |
| 3771 | In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may |
| 3772 | definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not |
| 3773 | be able to access the service anymore. |
| 3774 | |
| 3775 | Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their |
| 3776 | persistence and redistribute them to a working server. |
| 3777 | |
| 3778 | It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple |
| 3779 | connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero |
| 3780 | value. |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3781 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 25b501a | 2008-01-06 16:36:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3782 | This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and |
| 3783 | "redisp" keywords. |
| 3784 | |
| 3785 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3786 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3787 | |
Willy Tarreau | 4de9149 | 2010-01-22 19:10:05 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3788 | See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist" |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 25b501a | 2008-01-06 16:36:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3789 | |
Willy Tarreau | a453bdd | 2008-01-08 19:50:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3790 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | ec032d6 | 2011-08-05 16:23:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3791 | option redis-check |
| 3792 | Use redis health checks for server testing |
| 3793 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3794 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 3795 | Arguments : none |
| 3796 | |
| 3797 | It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead |
| 3798 | of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, |
| 3799 | a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to |
| 3800 | find the "+PONG" response message. |
| 3801 | |
| 3802 | Example : |
| 3803 | option redis-check |
| 3804 | |
| 3805 | See also : "option httpchk" |
| 3806 | |
| 3807 | |
Willy Tarreau | a453bdd | 2008-01-08 19:50:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3808 | option smtpchk |
| 3809 | option smtpchk <hello> <domain> |
| 3810 | Use SMTP health checks for server testing |
| 3811 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3812 | yes | no | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3813 | Arguments : |
Willy Tarreau | a453bdd | 2008-01-08 19:50:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3814 | <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can |
| 3815 | be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other |
| 3816 | values will be turned into the default command ("HELO"). |
| 3817 | |
| 3818 | <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be |
| 3819 | specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been |
| 3820 | specified. By default, "localhost" is used. |
| 3821 | |
| 3822 | When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP |
| 3823 | connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is |
| 3824 | "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes |
| 3825 | starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses, |
| 3826 | including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a |
| 3827 | dead server. |
| 3828 | |
| 3829 | This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the |
| 3830 | request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt, |
| 3831 | so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port |
| 3832 | 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration. |
| 3833 | |
| 3834 | Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for |
| 3835 | various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When |
| 3836 | possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when |
| 3837 | connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, |
| 3838 | which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in. |
| 3839 | |
| 3840 | Example : |
| 3841 | option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org |
| 3842 | |
| 3843 | See also : "option httpchk", "source" |
| 3844 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 25b501a | 2008-01-06 16:36:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3845 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | aeebf9b | 2009-10-04 15:43:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3846 | option socket-stats |
| 3847 | no option socket-stats |
| 3848 | |
| 3849 | Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket. |
| 3850 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3851 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 3852 | |
| 3853 | Arguments : none |
| 3854 | |
| 3855 | |
Willy Tarreau | ff4f82d | 2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3856 | option splice-auto |
| 3857 | no option splice-auto |
| 3858 | Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions |
| 3859 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3860 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 3861 | Arguments : none |
| 3862 | |
| 3863 | When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy |
| 3864 | will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to |
| 3865 | forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy |
| 3866 | uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3867 | not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used |
Willy Tarreau | ff4f82d | 2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3868 | are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This |
| 3869 | option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally |
| 3870 | disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it |
| 3871 | requires that there are enough spare pipes. |
| 3872 | |
| 3873 | Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which |
| 3874 | first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to |
| 3875 | transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus |
| 3876 | providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many |
| 3877 | early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this |
| 3878 | feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care. |
| 3879 | While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation, |
| 3880 | 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In |
| 3881 | case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice" |
| 3882 | keyword. |
| 3883 | |
| 3884 | Example : |
| 3885 | option splice-auto |
| 3886 | |
| 3887 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3888 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3889 | |
| 3890 | See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global |
| 3891 | options "nosplice" and "maxpipes" |
| 3892 | |
| 3893 | |
| 3894 | option splice-request |
| 3895 | no option splice-request |
| 3896 | Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests |
| 3897 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3898 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 3899 | Arguments : none |
| 3900 | |
| 3901 | When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy |
Jamie Gloudon | aaa2100 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 3902 | will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from |
Willy Tarreau | ff4f82d | 2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3903 | the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there |
| 3904 | are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at |
| 3905 | compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice". |
| 3906 | Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes. |
| 3907 | |
| 3908 | Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations. |
| 3909 | |
| 3910 | Example : |
| 3911 | option splice-request |
| 3912 | |
| 3913 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3914 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3915 | |
| 3916 | See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options |
| 3917 | "nosplice" and "maxpipes" |
| 3918 | |
| 3919 | |
| 3920 | option splice-response |
| 3921 | no option splice-response |
| 3922 | Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses |
| 3923 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3924 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 3925 | Arguments : none |
| 3926 | |
| 3927 | When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy |
Jamie Gloudon | aaa2100 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 3928 | will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from |
Willy Tarreau | ff4f82d | 2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3929 | the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there |
| 3930 | are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at |
| 3931 | compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice". |
| 3932 | Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes. |
| 3933 | |
| 3934 | Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations. |
| 3935 | |
| 3936 | Example : |
| 3937 | option splice-response |
| 3938 | |
| 3939 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3940 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3941 | |
| 3942 | See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options |
| 3943 | "nosplice" and "maxpipes" |
| 3944 | |
| 3945 | |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3946 | option srvtcpka |
| 3947 | no option srvtcpka |
| 3948 | Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side |
| 3949 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3950 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 3951 | Arguments : none |
| 3952 | |
| 3953 | When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and |
| 3954 | a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle |
| 3955 | periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate |
| 3956 | components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long. |
| 3957 | |
| 3958 | Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets |
| 3959 | to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between |
| 3960 | keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the |
| 3961 | operating system and its tuning parameters. |
| 3962 | |
| 3963 | It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor |
| 3964 | received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees |
| 3965 | them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives |
| 3966 | to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be |
| 3967 | forwarded to the other side of the proxy. |
| 3968 | |
| 3969 | Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive. |
| 3970 | |
| 3971 | Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the |
| 3972 | server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are |
| 3973 | noticed between HAProxy and a server. |
| 3974 | |
| 3975 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 3976 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 3977 | |
| 3978 | See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka" |
| 3979 | |
| 3980 | |
Willy Tarreau | a453bdd | 2008-01-08 19:50:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 3981 | option ssl-hello-chk |
| 3982 | Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing |
| 3983 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 3984 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 3985 | Arguments : none |
| 3986 | |
| 3987 | When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is |
| 3988 | possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing |
| 3989 | that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure |
| 3990 | SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to |
| 3991 | the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message. |
| 3992 | The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server |
| 3993 | hello message. |
| 3994 | |
| 3995 | All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages, |
| 3996 | and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello |
| 3997 | messages, which is appreciable. |
| 3998 | |
Willy Tarreau | 763a95b | 2012-10-04 23:15:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 3999 | Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy |
| 4000 | because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best |
| 4001 | to use native SSL health checks instead of this one. |
Willy Tarreau | a453bdd | 2008-01-08 19:50:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4002 | |
Willy Tarreau | 763a95b | 2012-10-04 23:15:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4003 | See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl" |
| 4004 | |
Willy Tarreau | a453bdd | 2008-01-08 19:50:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4005 | |
Willy Tarreau | 9ea05a7 | 2009-06-14 12:07:01 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4006 | option tcp-smart-accept |
| 4007 | no option tcp-smart-accept |
| 4008 | Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence |
| 4009 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4010 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 4011 | Arguments : none |
| 4012 | |
| 4013 | When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on |
| 4014 | behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the |
| 4015 | system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new |
| 4016 | connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we |
| 4017 | have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could |
| 4018 | very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response. |
| 4019 | |
| 4020 | For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid |
| 4021 | sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least |
| 4022 | Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway |
| 4023 | after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come. |
| 4024 | |
| 4025 | During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable |
| 4026 | this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex |
| 4027 | when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to |
| 4028 | fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept". |
| 4029 | |
| 4030 | It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying |
| 4031 | "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services |
| 4032 | such as SMTP where the server speaks first. |
| 4033 | |
| 4034 | It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case |
| 4035 | of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the |
| 4036 | "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword. |
| 4037 | |
Willy Tarreau | d88edf2 | 2009-06-14 15:48:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4038 | See also : "option tcp-smart-connect" |
| 4039 | |
| 4040 | |
| 4041 | option tcp-smart-connect |
| 4042 | no option tcp-smart-connect |
| 4043 | Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence |
| 4044 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4045 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 4046 | Arguments : none |
| 4047 | |
| 4048 | On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to |
| 4049 | immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly |
| 4050 | send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and |
| 4051 | thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they |
| 4052 | immediately get the request along with the incoming connection. |
| 4053 | |
| 4054 | This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend. |
| 4055 | It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more |
| 4056 | complex. |
| 4057 | |
| 4058 | It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first |
| 4059 | such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of |
| 4060 | the ACK, a normal ACK is sent. |
| 4061 | |
| 4062 | If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled |
| 4063 | in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. |
| 4064 | |
| 4065 | See also : "option tcp-smart-accept" |
| 4066 | |
Willy Tarreau | 9ea05a7 | 2009-06-14 12:07:01 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4067 | |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4068 | option tcpka |
| 4069 | Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides |
| 4070 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4071 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 4072 | Arguments : none |
| 4073 | |
| 4074 | When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and |
| 4075 | a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle |
| 4076 | periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate |
| 4077 | components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long. |
| 4078 | |
| 4079 | Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets |
| 4080 | to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between |
| 4081 | keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the |
| 4082 | operating system and its tuning parameters. |
| 4083 | |
| 4084 | It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor |
| 4085 | received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees |
| 4086 | them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives |
| 4087 | to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be |
| 4088 | forwarded to the other side of the proxy. |
| 4089 | |
| 4090 | Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive. |
| 4091 | |
| 4092 | Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both |
| 4093 | the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful |
| 4094 | only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a |
| 4095 | frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is |
| 4096 | used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this |
| 4097 | reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and |
| 4098 | "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and |
| 4099 | backends. |
| 4100 | |
| 4101 | See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka" |
| 4102 | |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4103 | |
| 4104 | option tcplog |
| 4105 | Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers |
| 4106 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4107 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 4108 | Arguments : none |
| 4109 | |
| 4110 | By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the |
| 4111 | source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying |
| 4112 | "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but |
| 4113 | not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections |
| 4114 | numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source |
| 4115 | address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to |
| 4116 | find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP |
| 4117 | proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete. |
| 4118 | |
| 4119 | This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend. |
| 4120 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4121 | See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging. |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4122 | |
| 4123 | |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4124 | option transparent |
| 4125 | no option transparent |
| 4126 | Enable client-side transparent proxying |
| 4127 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
Willy Tarreau | 4b1f859 | 2008-12-23 23:13:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4128 | yes | no | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4129 | Arguments : none |
| 4130 | |
| 4131 | This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3 |
| 4132 | load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming |
| 4133 | connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let |
| 4134 | this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is |
| 4135 | used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination |
| 4136 | IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another |
| 4137 | equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the |
| 4138 | appropriate server. |
| 4139 | |
| 4140 | Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy |
| 4141 | present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection. |
| 4142 | |
Willy Tarreau | a114605 | 2011-03-01 09:51:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4143 | See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4144 | "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword. |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4145 | |
Willy Tarreau | bf1f816 | 2007-12-28 17:42:56 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4146 | |
Emeric Brun | 647caf1 | 2009-06-30 17:57:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4147 | persist rdp-cookie |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4148 | persist rdp-cookie(<name>) |
Emeric Brun | 647caf1 | 2009-06-30 17:57:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4149 | Enable RDP cookie-based persistence |
| 4150 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4151 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 4152 | Arguments : |
| 4153 | <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the |
Willy Tarreau | 61e28f2 | 2010-05-16 22:31:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4154 | default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no |
| 4155 | valid reason to change this name. |
Emeric Brun | 647caf1 | 2009-06-30 17:57:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4156 | |
| 4157 | This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie |
| 4158 | contains all information required to find the server in the list of known |
| 4159 | servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed |
| 4160 | and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server |
| 4161 | which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is |
| 4162 | forwarded to this server. |
| 4163 | |
| 4164 | Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the |
| 4165 | frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present |
| 4166 | in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie" |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4167 | load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in |
Emeric Brun | 647caf1 | 2009-06-30 17:57:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4168 | a single "listen" section. |
| 4169 | |
Willy Tarreau | 61e28f2 | 2010-05-16 22:31:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4170 | Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this |
| 4171 | RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means |
| 4172 | that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled. |
| 4173 | |
Emeric Brun | 647caf1 | 2009-06-30 17:57:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4174 | Example : |
| 4175 | listen tse-farm |
| 4176 | bind :3389 |
| 4177 | # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request |
| 4178 | tcp-request inspect-delay 5s |
| 4179 | tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE |
| 4180 | # apply RDP cookie persistence |
| 4181 | persist rdp-cookie |
| 4182 | # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie. |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4183 | # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too. |
Emeric Brun | 647caf1 | 2009-06-30 17:57:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4184 | balance rdp-cookie |
| 4185 | server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389 |
| 4186 | server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389 |
| 4187 | |
Simon Horman | ab814e0 | 2011-06-24 14:50:20 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 4188 | See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and |
| 4189 | the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function. |
Emeric Brun | 647caf1 | 2009-06-30 17:57:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4190 | |
| 4191 | |
Willy Tarreau | 3a7d207 | 2009-03-05 23:48:25 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4192 | rate-limit sessions <rate> |
| 4193 | Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend |
| 4194 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4195 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 4196 | Arguments : |
| 4197 | <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number |
| 4198 | of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend. |
| 4199 | |
| 4200 | When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it |
| 4201 | stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again. |
| 4202 | During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog |
| 4203 | (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are |
| 4204 | pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make |
| 4205 | sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword. |
| 4206 | |
| 4207 | This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks |
| 4208 | or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every |
| 4209 | millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately, |
| 4210 | no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold. |
| 4211 | |
| 4212 | Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max |
| 4213 | listen smtp |
| 4214 | mode tcp |
| 4215 | bind :25 |
| 4216 | rate-limit sessions 10 |
| 4217 | server 127.0.0.1:1025 |
| 4218 | |
Willy Tarreau | a17c2d9 | 2011-07-25 08:16:20 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4219 | Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed |
| 4220 | but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the |
| 4221 | "socket-stats" option is enabled. |
Willy Tarreau | 3a7d207 | 2009-03-05 23:48:25 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4222 | |
| 4223 | See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion. |
| 4224 | |
| 4225 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2e1dca8 | 2012-09-12 08:43:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4226 | redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>] |
| 4227 | redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>] |
| 4228 | redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>] |
Willy Tarreau | b463dfb | 2008-06-07 23:08:56 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4229 | Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched |
| 4230 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4231 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4232 | |
| 4233 | If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect |
Willy Tarreau | f285f54 | 2010-01-03 20:03:03 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4234 | response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally. |
Willy Tarreau | b463dfb | 2008-06-07 23:08:56 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4235 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0140f25 | 2008-11-19 21:07:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4236 | Arguments : |
Willy Tarreau | 2e1dca8 | 2012-09-12 08:43:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4237 | <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into |
| 4238 | the HTTP "Location" header. |
| 4239 | |
| 4240 | <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the |
| 4241 | concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the |
| 4242 | query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see |
| 4243 | below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then |
| 4244 | nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to |
| 4245 | redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). |
| 4246 | |
| 4247 | <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by |
| 4248 | concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the |
| 4249 | "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string |
| 4250 | unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no |
| 4251 | path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If |
| 4252 | no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be |
| 4253 | returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to |
| 4254 | the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to |
| 4255 | HTTPS. |
Willy Tarreau | 0140f25 | 2008-11-19 21:07:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4256 | |
| 4257 | <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection |
| 4258 | is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is |
| 4259 | used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and |
| 4260 | a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently" |
| 4261 | and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303 |
| 4262 | is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the |
| 4263 | location with a GET method. |
| 4264 | |
| 4265 | <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the |
| 4266 | expected behaviour of a redirection : |
| 4267 | |
| 4268 | - "drop-query" |
| 4269 | When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the |
| 4270 | location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful |
| 4271 | for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect |
| 4272 | with a location-type redirect. |
| 4273 | |
Willy Tarreau | 81e3b4f | 2010-01-10 00:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4274 | - "append-slash" |
| 4275 | This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect |
| 4276 | users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'. |
| 4277 | It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL. |
| 4278 | For this, a return code 301 is preferred. |
| 4279 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0140f25 | 2008-11-19 21:07:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4280 | - "set-cookie NAME[=value]" |
| 4281 | A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value") |
| 4282 | to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has |
| 4283 | been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other |
| 4284 | cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note |
| 4285 | that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is |
| 4286 | different from a cookie with an equal sign. |
| 4287 | |
| 4288 | - "clear-cookie NAME[=]" |
| 4289 | A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but |
| 4290 | with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to |
| 4291 | delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is |
| 4292 | important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a |
| 4293 | cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for |
| 4294 | that, because the browser makes the difference. |
Willy Tarreau | b463dfb | 2008-06-07 23:08:56 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4295 | |
| 4296 | Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS. |
| 4297 | acl clear dst_port 80 |
| 4298 | acl secure dst_port 8080 |
| 4299 | acl login_page url_beg /login |
Willy Tarreau | 0140f25 | 2008-11-19 21:07:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4300 | acl logout url_beg /logout |
Willy Tarreau | 79da469 | 2008-11-19 20:03:04 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4301 | acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+ |
Willy Tarreau | 0140f25 | 2008-11-19 21:07:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4302 | acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1 |
| 4303 | |
| 4304 | redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set |
Willy Tarreau | 79da469 | 2008-11-19 20:03:04 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4305 | redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure |
| 4306 | redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given |
| 4307 | redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure |
Willy Tarreau | 0140f25 | 2008-11-19 21:07:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4308 | redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout |
Willy Tarreau | b463dfb | 2008-06-07 23:08:56 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4309 | |
Willy Tarreau | 81e3b4f | 2010-01-10 00:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4310 | Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'. |
| 4311 | acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$ |
| 4312 | redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash |
| 4313 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2e1dca8 | 2012-09-12 08:43:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4314 | Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy. |
| 4315 | redirect scheme https if !{ is_ssl } |
| 4316 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4317 | See section 7 about ACL usage. |
Willy Tarreau | b463dfb | 2008-06-07 23:08:56 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4318 | |
| 4319 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 25b501a | 2008-01-06 16:36:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4320 | redisp (deprecated) |
| 4321 | redispatch (deprecated) |
| 4322 | Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure |
| 4323 | May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4324 | yes | no | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4325 | Arguments : none |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 25b501a | 2008-01-06 16:36:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4326 | |
| 4327 | In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may |
| 4328 | definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not |
| 4329 | be able to access the service anymore. |
| 4330 | |
| 4331 | Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and |
| 4332 | redistribute them to a working server. |
| 4333 | |
| 4334 | It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple |
| 4335 | connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero |
| 4336 | value. |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4337 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 25b501a | 2008-01-06 16:36:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4338 | This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new |
| 4339 | "option redispatch" instead. |
| 4340 | |
| 4341 | See also : "option redispatch" |
| 4342 | |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4343 | |
Willy Tarreau | 8abd4cd | 2010-01-31 14:30:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4344 | reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4345 | Add a header at the end of the HTTP request |
| 4346 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4347 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4348 | Arguments : |
| 4349 | <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter |
| 4350 | must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4351 | 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4352 | |
Willy Tarreau | 8abd4cd | 2010-01-31 14:30:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4353 | <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it |
| 4354 | possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met. |
| 4355 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4356 | A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after |
| 4357 | the last header of an HTTP request. |
| 4358 | |
| 4359 | Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy, |
| 4360 | and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error |
| 4361 | responses. |
| 4362 | |
Willy Tarreau | 8abd4cd | 2010-01-31 14:30:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4363 | Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81 |
| 4364 | acl is-ssl dst_port 81 |
| 4365 | reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl |
| 4366 | |
| 4367 | See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 |
| 4368 | about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4369 | |
| 4370 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4371 | reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] |
| 4372 | reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4373 | Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression |
| 4374 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4375 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4376 | Arguments : |
| 4377 | <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the |
| 4378 | request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis |
| 4379 | grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required. |
| 4380 | Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash |
| 4381 | ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The |
| 4382 | "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow" |
| 4383 | ignores case. |
| 4384 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4385 | <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it |
| 4386 | possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met. |
| 4387 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4388 | A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression |
| 4389 | <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would |
| 4390 | result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request |
| 4391 | headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4392 | header names are not. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4393 | |
| 4394 | It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies. |
| 4395 | Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs. |
| 4396 | |
| 4397 | Example : |
| 4398 | # allow www.* but refuse *.local |
| 4399 | reqiallow ^Host:\ www\. |
| 4400 | reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local |
| 4401 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4402 | See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and |
| 4403 | section 7 about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4404 | |
| 4405 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4406 | reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] |
| 4407 | reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4408 | Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request |
| 4409 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4410 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4411 | Arguments : |
| 4412 | <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the |
| 4413 | request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis |
| 4414 | grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required. |
| 4415 | Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash |
| 4416 | ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel" |
| 4417 | keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case. |
| 4418 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4419 | <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it |
| 4420 | possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met. |
| 4421 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4422 | Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request |
| 4423 | will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted |
| 4424 | and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the |
| 4425 | next servers. |
| 4426 | |
| 4427 | Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy, |
| 4428 | and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error |
| 4429 | responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive. |
| 4430 | |
| 4431 | Example : |
| 4432 | # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie |
| 4433 | reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.* |
| 4434 | reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER= |
| 4435 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4436 | See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header |
| 4437 | manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4438 | |
| 4439 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4440 | reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] |
| 4441 | reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4442 | Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression |
| 4443 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4444 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4445 | Arguments : |
| 4446 | <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the |
| 4447 | request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis |
| 4448 | grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required. |
| 4449 | Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash |
| 4450 | ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The |
| 4451 | "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores |
| 4452 | case. |
| 4453 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4454 | <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it |
| 4455 | possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met. |
| 4456 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4457 | A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression |
| 4458 | <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would |
| 4459 | result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request |
| 4460 | headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4461 | header names are not. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4462 | |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4463 | A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4464 | complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4465 | using ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4466 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4467 | It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies. |
| 4468 | Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs. |
| 4469 | |
| 4470 | Example : |
| 4471 | # refuse *.local, then allow www.* |
| 4472 | reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local |
| 4473 | reqiallow ^Host:\ www\. |
| 4474 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4475 | See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header |
| 4476 | manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4477 | |
| 4478 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4479 | reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] |
| 4480 | reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4481 | Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules |
| 4482 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4483 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4484 | Arguments : |
| 4485 | <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the |
| 4486 | request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis |
| 4487 | grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required. |
| 4488 | Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash |
| 4489 | ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The |
| 4490 | "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores |
| 4491 | case. |
| 4492 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4493 | <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it |
| 4494 | possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met. |
| 4495 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4496 | A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression |
| 4497 | <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict. |
| 4498 | The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in |
| 4499 | mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not. |
| 4500 | |
| 4501 | It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies. |
| 4502 | Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs. |
| 4503 | |
| 4504 | Example : |
| 4505 | # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local" |
| 4506 | reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local |
| 4507 | reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local |
| 4508 | reqiallow ^Host:\ www\. |
| 4509 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4510 | See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header |
| 4511 | manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4512 | |
| 4513 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4514 | reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] |
| 4515 | reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4516 | Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line |
| 4517 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4518 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4519 | Arguments : |
| 4520 | <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the |
| 4521 | request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis |
| 4522 | grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required. |
| 4523 | Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash |
| 4524 | ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep" |
| 4525 | keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case. |
| 4526 | |
| 4527 | <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter |
| 4528 | must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched |
| 4529 | pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N |
| 4530 | being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4531 | 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4532 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4533 | <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it |
| 4534 | possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met. |
| 4535 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4536 | Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both |
| 4537 | the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>. |
| 4538 | Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers. |
| 4539 | |
| 4540 | Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy, |
| 4541 | and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error |
| 4542 | responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough |
| 4543 | spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in |
| 4544 | request line are case-sensitive while header names are not. |
| 4545 | |
| 4546 | Example : |
| 4547 | # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path. |
Dmitry Sivachenko | 7823de3 | 2012-05-16 14:00:26 +0400 | [diff] [blame] | 4548 | reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2 |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4549 | # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name. |
| 4550 | reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www |
| 4551 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4552 | See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header |
| 4553 | manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4554 | |
| 4555 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4556 | reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] |
| 4557 | reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4558 | Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression |
| 4559 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4560 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4561 | Arguments : |
| 4562 | <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the |
| 4563 | request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis |
| 4564 | grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required. |
| 4565 | Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash |
| 4566 | ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The |
| 4567 | "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit" |
| 4568 | ignores case. |
| 4569 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4570 | <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it |
| 4571 | possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met. |
| 4572 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4573 | A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression |
| 4574 | <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4575 | be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so |
| 4576 | that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will |
| 4577 | be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4578 | delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is |
| 4579 | not set. |
| 4580 | |
| 4581 | The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with |
| 4582 | identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections |
| 4583 | and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to |
| 4584 | come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly |
| 4585 | efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls. |
| 4586 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4587 | Examples : |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4588 | # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but |
| 4589 | # block all others. |
| 4590 | reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE) |
| 4591 | reqitarpit ^User-Agent: |
| 4592 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5321c42 | 2010-01-28 20:35:13 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4593 | # block bad guys |
| 4594 | acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28 |
| 4595 | reqitarpit . if badguys |
| 4596 | |
| 4597 | See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header |
| 4598 | manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4599 | |
| 4600 | |
Willy Tarreau | e5c5ce9 | 2008-06-20 17:27:19 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4601 | retries <value> |
| 4602 | Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure |
| 4603 | May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4604 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 4605 | Arguments : |
| 4606 | <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on |
| 4607 | a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The |
| 4608 | default value is 3. |
| 4609 | |
| 4610 | It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of |
| 4611 | connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively |
| 4612 | been established to a server, there will be no more retry. |
| 4613 | |
| 4614 | In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting, |
| 4615 | a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs. |
| 4616 | |
| 4617 | When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another |
| 4618 | server even if a cookie references a different server. |
| 4619 | |
| 4620 | See also : "option redispatch" |
| 4621 | |
| 4622 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4623 | rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4624 | Add a header at the end of the HTTP response |
| 4625 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4626 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4627 | Arguments : |
| 4628 | <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter |
| 4629 | must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4630 | 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4631 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4632 | <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it |
| 4633 | possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met. |
| 4634 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4635 | A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after |
| 4636 | the last header of an HTTP response. |
| 4637 | |
| 4638 | Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy, |
| 4639 | and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error |
| 4640 | responses. |
| 4641 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4642 | See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 |
| 4643 | about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4644 | |
| 4645 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4646 | rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] |
| 4647 | rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4648 | Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response |
| 4649 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4650 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4651 | Arguments : |
| 4652 | <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the |
| 4653 | response line. This is an extended regular expression, so |
| 4654 | parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash |
| 4655 | is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using |
| 4656 | a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. |
| 4657 | The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel" |
| 4658 | ignores case. |
| 4659 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4660 | <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it |
| 4661 | possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met. |
| 4662 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4663 | Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response |
| 4664 | will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted |
Willy Tarreau | 3c92c5f | 2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4665 | and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4666 | client. |
| 4667 | |
| 4668 | Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy, |
| 4669 | and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error |
| 4670 | responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive. |
| 4671 | |
| 4672 | Example : |
| 4673 | # remove the Server header from responses |
| 4674 | reqidel ^Server:.* |
| 4675 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4676 | See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header |
| 4677 | manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4678 | |
| 4679 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4680 | rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] |
| 4681 | rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4682 | Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression |
| 4683 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4684 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4685 | Arguments : |
| 4686 | <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the |
| 4687 | response line. This is an extended regular expression, so |
| 4688 | parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash |
| 4689 | is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using |
| 4690 | a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. |
| 4691 | The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny" |
| 4692 | ignores case. |
| 4693 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4694 | <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it |
| 4695 | possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met. |
| 4696 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4697 | A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression |
| 4698 | <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the |
| 4699 | response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not |
| 4700 | case-sensitive. |
| 4701 | |
| 4702 | Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4703 | block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it |
| 4704 | will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves |
| 4705 | any sensitive data. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4706 | |
| 4707 | It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies. |
| 4708 | Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs. |
| 4709 | |
| 4710 | Example : |
| 4711 | # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak |
| 4712 | rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word |
| 4713 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4714 | See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation |
| 4715 | and section 7 about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4716 | |
| 4717 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4718 | rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] |
| 4719 | rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4720 | Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line |
| 4721 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4722 | no | yes | yes | yes |
| 4723 | Arguments : |
| 4724 | <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the |
| 4725 | response line. This is an extended regular expression, so |
| 4726 | parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash |
| 4727 | is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using |
| 4728 | a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. |
| 4729 | The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep" |
| 4730 | ignores case. |
| 4731 | |
| 4732 | <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter |
| 4733 | must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched |
| 4734 | pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N |
| 4735 | being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4736 | 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4737 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4738 | <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it |
| 4739 | possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met. |
| 4740 | |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4741 | Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both |
| 4742 | the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with |
| 4743 | <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers. |
| 4744 | |
| 4745 | Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy, |
| 4746 | and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error |
| 4747 | responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough |
| 4748 | spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names |
| 4749 | are not case-sensitive. |
| 4750 | |
| 4751 | Example : |
| 4752 | # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com" |
| 4753 | rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com |
| 4754 | |
Willy Tarreau | fdb563c | 2010-01-31 15:43:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4755 | See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header |
| 4756 | manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | 303c035 | 2008-01-17 19:01:39 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4757 | |
| 4758 | |
David du Colombier | 486df47 | 2011-03-17 10:40:26 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4759 | server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*] |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4760 | Declare a server in a backend |
| 4761 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4762 | no | no | yes | yes |
| 4763 | Arguments : |
| 4764 | <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will |
Mark Lamourine | c2247f0 | 2012-01-04 13:02:01 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4765 | appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-server-name" is |
| 4766 | set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server. |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4767 | |
David du Colombier | 486df47 | 2011-03-17 10:40:26 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4768 | <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a |
| 4769 | resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved |
| 4770 | during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning. |
| 4771 | It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP |
Willy Tarreau | d669a4f | 2010-07-13 14:49:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4772 | address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in |
| 4773 | transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is |
| 4774 | intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination |
| 4775 | address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does |
| 4776 | except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and |
| 4777 | to report statistics. |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4778 | |
Willy Tarreau | b6205fd | 2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4779 | <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4780 | be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client |
| 4781 | connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+" |
| 4782 | or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by |
| 4783 | adding this value to the client's port. |
| 4784 | |
| 4785 | <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords |
| 4786 | accepts an important number of options and has a complete section |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4787 | dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details. |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4788 | |
| 4789 | Examples : |
| 4790 | server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000 |
| 4791 | server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000 |
| 4792 | |
Mark Lamourine | c2247f0 | 2012-01-04 13:02:01 -0500 | [diff] [blame] | 4793 | See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about |
| 4794 | server options |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4795 | |
| 4796 | |
| 4797 | source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ] |
Willy Tarreau | bce7088 | 2009-09-07 11:51:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4798 | source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ] |
Willy Tarreau | d53f96b | 2009-02-04 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4799 | source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>] |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4800 | Set the source address for outgoing connections |
| 4801 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4802 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 4803 | Arguments : |
| 4804 | <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a |
| 4805 | server. This address is also used as a source for health checks. |
| 4806 | The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select |
| 4807 | the most appropriate address to reach its destination. |
| 4808 | |
| 4809 | <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful |
| 4810 | in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means |
Willy Tarreau | c6f4ce8 | 2009-06-10 11:09:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4811 | the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not |
| 4812 | supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you |
| 4813 | have to specify them on each "server" line. |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4814 | |
| 4815 | <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are |
| 4816 | forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only |
| 4817 | supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is |
| 4818 | specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented |
| 4819 | with this address, while health checks will still use the address |
| 4820 | <addr>. |
| 4821 | |
| 4822 | <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections |
| 4823 | are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above). |
| 4824 | The default value of zero means the system will select a free |
| 4825 | port. |
| 4826 | |
Willy Tarreau | bce7088 | 2009-09-07 11:51:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4827 | <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to. |
| 4828 | This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can |
| 4829 | contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is |
| 4830 | used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header |
| 4831 | and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen |
| 4832 | by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another |
| 4833 | occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter |
| 4834 | below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding |
| 4835 | is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also |
| 4836 | keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any |
| 4837 | HTTP header. |
| 4838 | |
| 4839 | <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value |
| 4840 | header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)", |
Jamie Gloudon | aaa2100 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 4841 | in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP |
Willy Tarreau | bce7088 | 2009-09-07 11:51:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4842 | address. Positive values indicate a position from the first |
| 4843 | occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate |
| 4844 | positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This |
| 4845 | is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set |
| 4846 | at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several |
| 4847 | proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is |
| 4848 | assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature. |
| 4849 | |
Willy Tarreau | d53f96b | 2009-02-04 18:46:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4850 | <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing |
| 4851 | traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only |
| 4852 | Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to |
| 4853 | this interface even if it is not the one the system would select |
| 4854 | based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care. |
| 4855 | Note that using this option requires root privileges. |
| 4856 | |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4857 | The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific |
| 4858 | address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a |
| 4859 | private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is |
| 4860 | known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself. |
| 4861 | |
| 4862 | An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used |
| 4863 | through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the |
| 4864 | servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This |
| 4865 | is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination |
| 4866 | servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine |
| 4867 | running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine. |
| 4868 | |
| 4869 | In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP |
| 4870 | address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more |
| 4871 | common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this, |
| 4872 | there are two methods : |
| 4873 | |
| 4874 | - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent |
| 4875 | mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on |
| 4876 | the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different |
| 4877 | states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not |
| 4878 | limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all |
| 4879 | of the client ranges may be used. |
| 4880 | |
| 4881 | - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This |
| 4882 | solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream |
| 4883 | firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside |
| 4884 | of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports. |
| 4885 | However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP |
| 4886 | connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the |
| 4887 | same session. |
| 4888 | |
| 4889 | Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be |
| 4890 | required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an |
| 4891 | IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the |
| 4892 | IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing |
| 4893 | address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure |
| 4894 | forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation. |
| 4895 | |
| 4896 | This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may |
| 4897 | also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification |
| 4898 | is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4899 | section 5 for more information. |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4900 | |
| 4901 | Examples : |
| 4902 | backend private |
| 4903 | # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address |
| 4904 | source 192.168.1.200 |
| 4905 | |
| 4906 | backend transparent_ssl1 |
| 4907 | # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address |
| 4908 | source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip |
| 4909 | |
| 4910 | backend transparent_ssl2 |
| 4911 | # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port |
| 4912 | # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine. |
| 4913 | source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client |
| 4914 | |
| 4915 | backend transparent_ssl3 |
| 4916 | # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It |
| 4917 | # is more conntrack-friendly. |
| 4918 | source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip |
| 4919 | |
| 4920 | backend transparent_smtp |
| 4921 | # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port |
| 4922 | # with Tproxy version 4. |
| 4923 | source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip |
| 4924 | |
Willy Tarreau | bce7088 | 2009-09-07 11:51:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4925 | backend transparent_http |
| 4926 | # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous |
| 4927 | # proxy. |
| 4928 | source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1) |
| 4929 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4930 | See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4931 | the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword. |
| 4932 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 25b501a | 2008-01-06 16:36:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4933 | |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4934 | srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated) |
| 4935 | Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side. |
| 4936 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4937 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 4938 | Arguments : |
| 4939 | <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but |
| 4940 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 4941 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 4942 | |
| 4943 | The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or |
| 4944 | send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider |
| 4945 | during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the |
| 4946 | headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the |
| 4947 | request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with |
| 4948 | what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs |
| 4949 | to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly. |
| 4950 | |
| 4951 | The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other |
| 4952 | unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this |
| 4953 | document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly |
| 4954 | recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in |
| 4955 | order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4956 | response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4957 | packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4958 | seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4959 | |
| 4960 | This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in |
| 4961 | "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to |
| 4962 | forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which |
| 4963 | is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning |
| 4964 | during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in |
| 4965 | the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either. |
| 4966 | |
| 4967 | This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated. |
| 4968 | Please use "timeout server" instead. |
| 4969 | |
Willy Tarreau | ce887fd | 2012-05-12 12:50:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4970 | See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and |
| 4971 | "clitimeout". |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4972 | |
| 4973 | |
Cyril Bonté | 66c327d | 2010-10-12 00:14:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4974 | stats admin { if | unless } <cond> |
| 4975 | Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched |
| 4976 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 4977 | no | no | yes | yes |
| 4978 | |
| 4979 | This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is |
| 4980 | matched. |
| 4981 | |
| 4982 | The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By |
| 4983 | default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons. |
| 4984 | |
Cyril Bonté | 02ff8ef | 2010-12-14 22:48:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4985 | Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1) |
| 4986 | unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the |
| 4987 | processes, which can result in random behaviours. |
| 4988 | |
Cyril Bonté | 23b39d9 | 2011-02-10 22:54:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 4989 | Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved |
| 4990 | buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the |
| 4991 | request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a |
| 4992 | time. |
Cyril Bonté | 66c327d | 2010-10-12 00:14:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 4993 | |
| 4994 | Example : |
| 4995 | # statistics admin level only for localhost |
| 4996 | backend stats_localhost |
| 4997 | stats enable |
| 4998 | stats admin if LOCALHOST |
| 4999 | |
| 5000 | Example : |
| 5001 | # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication |
| 5002 | backend stats_auth |
| 5003 | stats enable |
| 5004 | stats auth admin:AdMiN123 |
| 5005 | stats admin if TRUE |
| 5006 | |
| 5007 | Example : |
| 5008 | # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user |
| 5009 | userlist stats-auth |
| 5010 | group admin users admin |
| 5011 | user admin insecure-password AdMiN123 |
| 5012 | group readonly users haproxy |
| 5013 | user haproxy insecure-password haproxy |
| 5014 | |
| 5015 | backend stats_auth |
| 5016 | stats enable |
| 5017 | acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth) |
| 5018 | acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin |
| 5019 | stats http-request auth unless AUTH |
| 5020 | stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN |
| 5021 | |
Cyril Bonté | 02ff8ef | 2010-12-14 22:48:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5022 | See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc", |
| 5023 | "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about |
| 5024 | ACL usage. |
Cyril Bonté | 66c327d | 2010-10-12 00:14:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5025 | |
| 5026 | |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5027 | stats auth <user>:<passwd> |
| 5028 | Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account |
| 5029 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5030 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 5031 | Arguments : |
| 5032 | <user> is a user name to grant access to |
| 5033 | |
| 5034 | <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user |
| 5035 | |
| 5036 | This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access |
| 5037 | to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to |
| 5038 | allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics |
| 5039 | without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that |
| 5040 | the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real |
| 5041 | which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm". |
| 5042 | |
| 5043 | Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords |
| 5044 | circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the |
| 5045 | configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users |
Willy Tarreau | 3c92c5f | 2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5046 | that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account. |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5047 | |
| 5048 | It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the |
| 5049 | report using "stats scope". |
| 5050 | |
| 5051 | Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is |
| 5052 | recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default |
| 5053 | unobvious parameters. |
| 5054 | |
| 5055 | Example : |
| 5056 | # public access (limited to this backend only) |
| 5057 | backend public_www |
| 5058 | server srv1 192.168.0.1:80 |
| 5059 | stats enable |
| 5060 | stats hide-version |
| 5061 | stats scope . |
| 5062 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5063 | stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics |
| 5064 | stats auth admin1:AdMiN123 |
| 5065 | stats auth admin2:AdMiN321 |
| 5066 | |
| 5067 | # internal monitoring access (unlimited) |
| 5068 | backend private_monitoring |
| 5069 | stats enable |
| 5070 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5071 | stats refresh 5s |
| 5072 | |
| 5073 | See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri" |
| 5074 | |
| 5075 | |
| 5076 | stats enable |
| 5077 | Enable statistics reporting with default settings |
| 5078 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5079 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 5080 | Arguments : none |
| 5081 | |
| 5082 | This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined |
| 5083 | at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used : |
| 5084 | - stats uri : /haproxy?stats |
| 5085 | - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics" |
| 5086 | - stats auth : no authentication |
| 5087 | - stats scope : no restriction |
| 5088 | |
| 5089 | Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is |
| 5090 | recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default |
| 5091 | unobvious parameters. |
| 5092 | |
| 5093 | Example : |
| 5094 | # public access (limited to this backend only) |
| 5095 | backend public_www |
| 5096 | server srv1 192.168.0.1:80 |
| 5097 | stats enable |
| 5098 | stats hide-version |
| 5099 | stats scope . |
| 5100 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5101 | stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics |
| 5102 | stats auth admin1:AdMiN123 |
| 5103 | stats auth admin2:AdMiN321 |
| 5104 | |
| 5105 | # internal monitoring access (unlimited) |
| 5106 | backend private_monitoring |
| 5107 | stats enable |
| 5108 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5109 | stats refresh 5s |
| 5110 | |
| 5111 | See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri" |
| 5112 | |
| 5113 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5114 | stats hide-version |
| 5115 | Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting |
Willy Tarreau | 1d45b7c | 2009-08-16 10:29:18 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5116 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5117 | yes | no | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5118 | Arguments : none |
Willy Tarreau | 1d45b7c | 2009-08-16 10:29:18 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5119 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5120 | By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with |
| 5121 | the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally |
| 5122 | considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them |
| 5123 | target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version" |
| 5124 | statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended |
| 5125 | for public sites or any site with a weak login/password. |
Willy Tarreau | 1d45b7c | 2009-08-16 10:29:18 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5126 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 48cb2ae | 2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5127 | Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is |
| 5128 | recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default |
| 5129 | unobvious parameters. |
| 5130 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5131 | Example : |
| 5132 | # public access (limited to this backend only) |
| 5133 | backend public_www |
| 5134 | server srv1 192.168.0.1:80 |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 48cb2ae | 2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5135 | stats enable |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5136 | stats hide-version |
| 5137 | stats scope . |
| 5138 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5139 | stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics |
| 5140 | stats auth admin1:AdMiN123 |
| 5141 | stats auth admin2:AdMiN321 |
Willy Tarreau | 1d45b7c | 2009-08-16 10:29:18 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5142 | |
Willy Tarreau | 1d45b7c | 2009-08-16 10:29:18 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5143 | # internal monitoring access (unlimited) |
| 5144 | backend private_monitoring |
| 5145 | stats enable |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5146 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5147 | stats refresh 5s |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 15514c2 | 2010-01-04 16:03:09 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5148 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5149 | See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri" |
Willy Tarreau | 1d45b7c | 2009-08-16 10:29:18 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5150 | |
Willy Tarreau | 983e01e | 2010-01-11 18:42:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5151 | |
Cyril Bonté | 2be1b3f | 2010-09-30 23:46:30 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5152 | stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] } |
| 5153 | [ { if | unless } <condition> ] |
| 5154 | Access control for statistics |
| 5155 | |
| 5156 | May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5157 | no | no | yes | yes |
| 5158 | |
| 5159 | As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to |
| 5160 | statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl. |
| 5161 | First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final. |
| 5162 | For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is |
| 5163 | performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client |
| 5164 | should be asked to enter a username and password. |
| 5165 | |
| 5166 | There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per |
| 5167 | instance. |
| 5168 | |
| 5169 | See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 |
| 5170 | about ACL usage. |
| 5171 | |
| 5172 | |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5173 | stats realm <realm> |
| 5174 | Enable statistics and set authentication realm |
| 5175 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5176 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 5177 | Arguments : |
| 5178 | <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to |
| 5179 | the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up |
| 5180 | inviting the user to enter a valid username and password. |
| 5181 | |
| 5182 | The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped |
| 5183 | using a backslash ('\'). |
| 5184 | |
| 5185 | This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is |
| 5186 | only related to authentication. |
| 5187 | |
| 5188 | Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is |
| 5189 | recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default |
| 5190 | unobvious parameters. |
| 5191 | |
| 5192 | Example : |
| 5193 | # public access (limited to this backend only) |
| 5194 | backend public_www |
| 5195 | server srv1 192.168.0.1:80 |
| 5196 | stats enable |
| 5197 | stats hide-version |
| 5198 | stats scope . |
| 5199 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5200 | stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics |
| 5201 | stats auth admin1:AdMiN123 |
| 5202 | stats auth admin2:AdMiN321 |
| 5203 | |
| 5204 | # internal monitoring access (unlimited) |
| 5205 | backend private_monitoring |
| 5206 | stats enable |
| 5207 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5208 | stats refresh 5s |
| 5209 | |
| 5210 | See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri" |
| 5211 | |
| 5212 | |
| 5213 | stats refresh <delay> |
| 5214 | Enable statistics with automatic refresh |
| 5215 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5216 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 5217 | Arguments : |
| 5218 | <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will |
| 5219 | be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the |
| 5220 | browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it |
| 5221 | and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may |
| 5222 | be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the |
| 5223 | unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document. |
| 5224 | |
| 5225 | This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page |
| 5226 | reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will |
| 5227 | include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether |
| 5228 | he wants automatic refresh of the page or not. |
| 5229 | |
| 5230 | Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is |
| 5231 | recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default |
| 5232 | unobvious parameters. |
| 5233 | |
| 5234 | Example : |
| 5235 | # public access (limited to this backend only) |
| 5236 | backend public_www |
| 5237 | server srv1 192.168.0.1:80 |
| 5238 | stats enable |
| 5239 | stats hide-version |
| 5240 | stats scope . |
| 5241 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5242 | stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics |
| 5243 | stats auth admin1:AdMiN123 |
| 5244 | stats auth admin2:AdMiN321 |
| 5245 | |
| 5246 | # internal monitoring access (unlimited) |
| 5247 | backend private_monitoring |
| 5248 | stats enable |
| 5249 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5250 | stats refresh 5s |
| 5251 | |
| 5252 | See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri" |
| 5253 | |
| 5254 | |
| 5255 | stats scope { <name> | "." } |
| 5256 | Enable statistics and limit access scope |
| 5257 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5258 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 5259 | Arguments : |
| 5260 | <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be |
| 5261 | reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the |
| 5262 | section in which the statement appears. |
| 5263 | |
| 5264 | When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this |
| 5265 | statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This |
| 5266 | statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be |
| 5267 | reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string |
| 5268 | comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really |
| 5269 | exists. |
| 5270 | |
| 5271 | Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is |
| 5272 | recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default |
| 5273 | unobvious parameters. |
| 5274 | |
| 5275 | Example : |
| 5276 | # public access (limited to this backend only) |
| 5277 | backend public_www |
| 5278 | server srv1 192.168.0.1:80 |
| 5279 | stats enable |
| 5280 | stats hide-version |
| 5281 | stats scope . |
| 5282 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5283 | stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics |
| 5284 | stats auth admin1:AdMiN123 |
| 5285 | stats auth admin2:AdMiN321 |
| 5286 | |
| 5287 | # internal monitoring access (unlimited) |
| 5288 | backend private_monitoring |
| 5289 | stats enable |
| 5290 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5291 | stats refresh 5s |
| 5292 | |
| 5293 | See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri" |
| 5294 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5295 | |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5296 | stats show-desc [ <desc> ] |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5297 | Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page. |
| 5298 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5299 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 5300 | |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5301 | <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5302 | description from global section is automatically used instead. |
| 5303 | |
| 5304 | This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their |
| 5305 | customers, where node or description should be different for each customer. |
| 5306 | |
| 5307 | Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is |
| 5308 | recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default |
Dmitry Sivachenko | 7823de3 | 2012-05-16 14:00:26 +0400 | [diff] [blame] | 5309 | unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown. |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5310 | |
| 5311 | Example : |
| 5312 | # internal monitoring access (unlimited) |
| 5313 | backend private_monitoring |
| 5314 | stats enable |
| 5315 | stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa |
| 5316 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5317 | stats refresh 5s |
| 5318 | |
| 5319 | See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in |
| 5320 | global section. |
| 5321 | |
| 5322 | |
| 5323 | stats show-legends |
| 5324 | Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page : |
| 5325 | - cap: capabilities (proxy) |
| 5326 | - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy) |
| 5327 | - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server) |
| 5328 | - IP (socket, server) |
| 5329 | - cookie (backend, server) |
| 5330 | |
| 5331 | Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is |
| 5332 | recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default |
Dmitry Sivachenko | 7823de3 | 2012-05-16 14:00:26 +0400 | [diff] [blame] | 5333 | unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information. |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5334 | |
| 5335 | See also: "stats enable", "stats uri". |
| 5336 | |
| 5337 | |
| 5338 | stats show-node [ <name> ] |
| 5339 | Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page. |
| 5340 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5341 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 5342 | Arguments: |
| 5343 | <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the |
| 5344 | node name from global section is automatically used instead. |
| 5345 | |
| 5346 | This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their |
| 5347 | customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page |
Dmitry Sivachenko | 7823de3 | 2012-05-16 14:00:26 +0400 | [diff] [blame] | 5348 | provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name. |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5349 | |
| 5350 | Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is |
| 5351 | recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default |
| 5352 | unobvious parameters. |
| 5353 | |
| 5354 | Example: |
| 5355 | # internal monitoring access (unlimited) |
| 5356 | backend private_monitoring |
| 5357 | stats enable |
| 5358 | stats show-node Europe-1 |
| 5359 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5360 | stats refresh 5s |
| 5361 | |
| 5362 | See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global |
| 5363 | section. |
| 5364 | |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5365 | |
| 5366 | stats uri <prefix> |
| 5367 | Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them |
| 5368 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5369 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 5370 | Arguments : |
| 5371 | <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This |
| 5372 | prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a |
| 5373 | query string. |
| 5374 | |
| 5375 | The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a |
| 5376 | page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the |
| 5377 | selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be |
| 5378 | possible to reach it in the application. |
| 5379 | |
| 5380 | The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5381 | changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here. |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5382 | It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that |
| 5383 | intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string |
| 5384 | beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question |
| 5385 | mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words. |
| 5386 | |
| 5387 | It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that |
| 5388 | statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate |
| 5389 | an address or a port to statistics only. |
| 5390 | |
| 5391 | Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is |
| 5392 | recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default |
| 5393 | unobvious parameters. |
| 5394 | |
| 5395 | Example : |
| 5396 | # public access (limited to this backend only) |
| 5397 | backend public_www |
| 5398 | server srv1 192.168.0.1:80 |
| 5399 | stats enable |
| 5400 | stats hide-version |
| 5401 | stats scope . |
| 5402 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5403 | stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics |
| 5404 | stats auth admin1:AdMiN123 |
| 5405 | stats auth admin2:AdMiN321 |
| 5406 | |
| 5407 | # internal monitoring access (unlimited) |
| 5408 | backend private_monitoring |
| 5409 | stats enable |
| 5410 | stats uri /admin?stats |
| 5411 | stats refresh 5s |
| 5412 | |
| 5413 | See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm" |
| 5414 | |
| 5415 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5416 | stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>] |
| 5417 | Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server |
Willy Tarreau | eabeafa | 2008-01-16 16:17:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5418 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5419 | no | no | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5420 | |
| 5421 | Arguments : |
| 5422 | <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It |
| 5423 | describes what elements of the incoming request or connection |
| 5424 | will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a |
| 5425 | stickiness table. This rule is mandatory. |
| 5426 | |
| 5427 | <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same |
| 5428 | backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using |
| 5429 | the "stick-table" statement. |
| 5430 | |
| 5431 | <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match |
| 5432 | on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or |
| 5433 | not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP |
| 5434 | address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in |
| 5435 | which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address. |
| 5436 | |
| 5437 | Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot |
| 5438 | always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement |
| 5439 | describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request |
| 5440 | or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and |
| 5441 | transformation rules. |
| 5442 | |
| 5443 | The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of |
| 5444 | a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present |
| 5445 | in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by |
| 5446 | referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced, |
| 5447 | the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs |
| 5448 | start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of |
| 5449 | doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting. |
| 5450 | |
| 5451 | It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement |
| 5452 | will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for |
| 5453 | ACL based conditions. |
| 5454 | |
| 5455 | There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that |
| 5456 | applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server |
| 5457 | as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple |
| 5458 | matches can be used as fallbacks. |
| 5459 | |
| 5460 | The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not |
| 5461 | affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That |
| 5462 | way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in |
| 5463 | order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS. |
| 5464 | |
Cyril Bonté | 02ff8ef | 2010-12-14 22:48:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5465 | Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1) |
| 5466 | unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the |
| 5467 | processes, which can result in random behaviours. |
| 5468 | |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5469 | Example : |
| 5470 | # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the |
| 5471 | # last 30 minutes |
| 5472 | backend pop |
| 5473 | mode tcp |
| 5474 | balance roundrobin |
| 5475 | stick store-request src |
| 5476 | stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m |
| 5477 | server s1 192.168.1.1:110 |
| 5478 | server s2 192.168.1.1:110 |
| 5479 | |
| 5480 | backend smtp |
| 5481 | mode tcp |
| 5482 | balance roundrobin |
| 5483 | stick match src table pop |
| 5484 | server s1 192.168.1.1:25 |
| 5485 | server s2 192.168.1.1:25 |
| 5486 | |
Cyril Bonté | 02ff8ef | 2010-12-14 22:48:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5487 | See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7 |
| 5488 | about ACLs and pattern extraction. |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5489 | |
| 5490 | |
| 5491 | stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>] |
| 5492 | Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server |
| 5493 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5494 | no | no | yes | yes |
| 5495 | |
| 5496 | Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by |
| 5497 | "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer |
| 5498 | to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience |
| 5499 | for writing more maintainable configurations. |
| 5500 | |
Cyril Bonté | 02ff8ef | 2010-12-14 22:48:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5501 | Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1) |
| 5502 | unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the |
| 5503 | processes, which can result in random behaviours. |
| 5504 | |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5505 | Examples : |
| 5506 | # The following form ... |
Willy Tarreau | ec579d8 | 2010-02-26 19:15:04 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5507 | stick on src table pop if !localhost |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5508 | |
| 5509 | # ...is strictly equivalent to this one : |
| 5510 | stick match src table pop if !localhost |
| 5511 | stick store-request src table pop if !localhost |
| 5512 | |
| 5513 | |
| 5514 | # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as |
| 5515 | # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses. |
| 5516 | backend http |
| 5517 | mode http |
| 5518 | balance roundrobin |
| 5519 | stick on src table https |
| 5520 | cookie SRV insert indirect nocache |
| 5521 | server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1 |
| 5522 | server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2 |
| 5523 | |
| 5524 | backend https |
| 5525 | mode tcp |
| 5526 | balance roundrobin |
| 5527 | stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m |
| 5528 | stick on src |
| 5529 | server s1 192.168.1.1:443 |
| 5530 | server s2 192.168.1.1:443 |
| 5531 | |
Cyril Bonté | 02ff8ef | 2010-12-14 22:48:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5532 | See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process". |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5533 | |
| 5534 | |
| 5535 | stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>] |
| 5536 | Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table |
| 5537 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5538 | no | no | yes | yes |
| 5539 | |
| 5540 | Arguments : |
| 5541 | <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It |
| 5542 | describes what elements of the incoming request or connection |
| 5543 | will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a |
| 5544 | server is selected. |
| 5545 | |
| 5546 | <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same |
| 5547 | backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using |
| 5548 | the "stick-table" statement. |
| 5549 | |
| 5550 | <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store |
| 5551 | certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met). |
| 5552 | For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address |
| 5553 | except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which |
| 5554 | case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP |
| 5555 | address. |
| 5556 | |
| 5557 | Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot |
| 5558 | always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement |
| 5559 | describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do |
| 5560 | it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to |
| 5561 | match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must |
| 5562 | make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a |
| 5563 | client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a |
| 5564 | URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make |
| 5565 | any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete |
| 5566 | list of possible patterns and transformation rules. |
| 5567 | |
| 5568 | The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of |
| 5569 | a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present |
| 5570 | in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by |
| 5571 | referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced, |
| 5572 | the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs |
| 5573 | start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of |
| 5574 | doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting. |
| 5575 | |
| 5576 | It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request" |
| 5577 | statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This |
| 5578 | condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be |
| 5579 | used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions. |
| 5580 | |
| 5581 | There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but |
| 5582 | there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This |
| 5583 | makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the |
| 5584 | request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first |
| 5585 | ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple |
| 5586 | tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on |
| 5587 | another protocol or access method. |
| 5588 | |
| 5589 | The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been |
| 5590 | established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed |
| 5591 | the request. |
| 5592 | |
Cyril Bonté | 02ff8ef | 2010-12-14 22:48:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5593 | Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1) |
| 5594 | unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the |
| 5595 | processes, which can result in random behaviours. |
| 5596 | |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5597 | Example : |
| 5598 | # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the |
| 5599 | # last 30 minutes |
| 5600 | backend pop |
| 5601 | mode tcp |
| 5602 | balance roundrobin |
| 5603 | stick store-request src |
| 5604 | stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m |
| 5605 | server s1 192.168.1.1:110 |
| 5606 | server s2 192.168.1.1:110 |
| 5607 | |
| 5608 | backend smtp |
| 5609 | mode tcp |
| 5610 | balance roundrobin |
| 5611 | stick match src table pop |
| 5612 | server s1 192.168.1.1:25 |
| 5613 | server s2 192.168.1.1:25 |
| 5614 | |
Cyril Bonté | 02ff8ef | 2010-12-14 22:48:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5615 | See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7 |
| 5616 | about ACLs and pattern extraction. |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5617 | |
| 5618 | |
Emeric Brun | 7c6b82e | 2010-09-24 16:34:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5619 | stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]} |
Emeric Brun | f099e79 | 2010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5620 | size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] |
| 5621 | [store <data_type>]* |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5622 | Configure the stickiness table for the current backend |
| 5623 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
Willy Tarreau | c00cdc2 | 2010-06-06 16:48:26 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5624 | no | yes | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5625 | |
| 5626 | Arguments : |
| 5627 | ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses. |
| 5628 | This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows |
| 5629 | very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This |
| 5630 | is mainly used to store client source IP addresses. |
| 5631 | |
David du Colombier | 9a6d3c9 | 2011-03-17 10:40:24 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5632 | ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses. |
| 5633 | This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows |
| 5634 | very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This |
| 5635 | is mainly used to store client source IP addresses. |
| 5636 | |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5637 | integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers |
| 5638 | which can represent a client identifier found in a request for |
| 5639 | instance. |
| 5640 | |
| 5641 | string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up |
| 5642 | to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern |
| 5643 | extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before |
| 5644 | being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be |
| 5645 | compared between the string in the table and the extracted |
| 5646 | pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited |
Emeric Brun | 7c6b82e | 2010-09-24 16:34:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5647 | to 32 characters. |
| 5648 | |
| 5649 | binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks |
| 5650 | of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern |
| 5651 | extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before |
| 5652 | being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor |
| 5653 | is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not |
| 5654 | specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes. |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5655 | |
| 5656 | <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a |
Emeric Brun | 7c6b82e | 2010-09-24 16:34:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5657 | "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number |
| 5658 | of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5659 | changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally |
| 5660 | increase. |
| 5661 | |
| 5662 | <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5663 | value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately |
| 5664 | 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size |
| 5665 | supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors. |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5666 | |
| 5667 | [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table |
| 5668 | is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy |
| 5669 | wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest |
| 5670 | entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is |
| 5671 | most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it |
| 5672 | be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older |
| 5673 | ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is |
| 5674 | far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access |
| 5675 | to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When |
| 5676 | using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire" |
| 5677 | parameter (see below). |
| 5678 | |
Emeric Brun | f099e79 | 2010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5679 | <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries |
| 5680 | which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with |
| 5681 | the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also |
| 5682 | automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a |
| 5683 | soft restart. |
| 5684 | |
Cyril Bonté | 02ff8ef | 2010-12-14 22:48:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5685 | NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode. |
| 5686 | |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5687 | <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it |
| 5688 | was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is |
| 5689 | defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various |
| 5690 | timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See |
| 5691 | section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified, |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5692 | the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5693 | be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter |
| 5694 | if not expiration delay is specified. |
| 5695 | |
Willy Tarreau | 08d5f98 | 2010-06-06 13:34:54 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5696 | <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This |
| 5697 | may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related |
| 5698 | to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each |
| 5699 | item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5700 | that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be |
| 5701 | stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after |
| 5702 | the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively, |
| 5703 | it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or |
| 5704 | several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is |
| 5705 | automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be |
| 5706 | explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data |
| 5707 | type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some |
| 5708 | data types require an argument which must be passed just after |
| 5709 | the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data |
| 5710 | types and their arguments. |
| 5711 | |
| 5712 | The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following : |
| 5713 | - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a |
| 5714 | request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store", |
| 5715 | and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced. |
| 5716 | |
| 5717 | - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer |
| 5718 | integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used |
| 5719 | to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a |
| 5720 | specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches. |
| 5721 | |
| 5722 | - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts |
| 5723 | the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched |
| 5724 | this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that |
| 5725 | they were received. |
| 5726 | |
| 5727 | - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which |
| 5728 | stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented |
| 5729 | once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the |
| 5730 | connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact |
| 5731 | number of concurrent connections for an entry. |
| 5732 | |
| 5733 | - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an |
| 5734 | integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length |
| 5735 | of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average |
| 5736 | incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The |
| 5737 | result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs. |
| 5738 | |
| 5739 | - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts |
| 5740 | the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this |
| 5741 | entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules. |
| 5742 | |
| 5743 | - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an |
| 5744 | integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length |
| 5745 | of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average |
| 5746 | incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The |
| 5747 | result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs. |
| 5748 | |
| 5749 | - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which |
| 5750 | counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which |
| 5751 | matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or |
| 5752 | not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on |
| 5753 | the client side. |
| 5754 | |
| 5755 | - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an |
| 5756 | integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length |
| 5757 | of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average |
| 5758 | HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is |
| 5759 | an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether |
| 5760 | they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions |
| 5761 | when keep-alive is used on the client side. |
| 5762 | |
| 5763 | - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which |
| 5764 | counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients |
| 5765 | which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated |
| 5766 | requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed |
| 5767 | authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is |
| 5768 | also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client |
| 5769 | (eg: vulnerability scan). |
| 5770 | |
| 5771 | - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an |
| 5772 | integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length |
| 5773 | of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average |
| 5774 | HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see |
| 5775 | http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an |
| 5776 | integer which can be matched using ACLs. |
| 5777 | |
| 5778 | - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit |
| 5779 | integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients |
| 5780 | which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be |
| 5781 | used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers. |
| 5782 | |
| 5783 | - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an |
| 5784 | integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length |
| 5785 | of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average |
| 5786 | incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used |
| 5787 | to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large |
| 5788 | uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted |
| 5789 | once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed |
| 5790 | instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with |
| 5791 | "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is |
| 5792 | recommended for better fairness. |
| 5793 | |
| 5794 | - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit |
| 5795 | integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which |
| 5796 | matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used |
| 5797 | to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site. |
| 5798 | |
| 5799 | - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes |
| 5800 | an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length |
| 5801 | of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average |
| 5802 | outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used |
| 5803 | to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large |
| 5804 | transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be |
| 5805 | counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average |
| 5806 | transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be |
| 5807 | smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of |
| 5808 | byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness. |
Willy Tarreau | 08d5f98 | 2010-06-06 13:34:54 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5809 | |
Willy Tarreau | c00cdc2 | 2010-06-06 16:48:26 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5810 | There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc, |
| 5811 | it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5812 | to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and |
| 5813 | reference it. |
| 5814 | |
| 5815 | It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information |
| 5816 | has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are |
| 5817 | lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always |
| 5818 | as an exclusive stickiness. |
| 5819 | |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5820 | Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types. |
| 5821 | Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes |
| 5822 | per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not |
| 5823 | something that can be ignored. |
| 5824 | |
| 5825 | Example: |
| 5826 | # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes |
| 5827 | # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate |
| 5828 | # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds. |
| 5829 | stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s) |
| 5830 | |
| 5831 | See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2 |
David du Colombier | a13d1b9 | 2011-03-17 10:40:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5832 | about time format and section 7 about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 5833 | |
| 5834 | |
Emeric Brun | 6a1cefa | 2010-09-24 18:15:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5835 | stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>] |
| 5836 | Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table |
| 5837 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5838 | no | no | yes | yes |
| 5839 | |
| 5840 | Arguments : |
| 5841 | <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It |
| 5842 | describes what elements of the response or connection will |
| 5843 | be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a |
| 5844 | server is selected. |
| 5845 | |
| 5846 | <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same |
| 5847 | backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using |
| 5848 | the "stick-table" statement. |
| 5849 | |
| 5850 | <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store |
| 5851 | certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met). |
| 5852 | For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only |
| 5853 | when the response is a SSL server hello. |
| 5854 | |
| 5855 | Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot |
| 5856 | always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response" |
| 5857 | statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and |
| 5858 | when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further |
| 5859 | requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the |
| 5860 | extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5861 | request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense. |
Emeric Brun | 6a1cefa | 2010-09-24 18:15:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5862 | See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation |
| 5863 | rules. |
| 5864 | |
| 5865 | The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of |
| 5866 | a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present |
| 5867 | in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by |
| 5868 | referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced, |
| 5869 | the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs |
| 5870 | start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of |
| 5871 | doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting. |
| 5872 | |
| 5873 | It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response" |
| 5874 | statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This |
| 5875 | condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can |
| 5876 | be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions. |
| 5877 | |
| 5878 | There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but |
| 5879 | there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This |
| 5880 | makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the |
| 5881 | request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first |
| 5882 | ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple |
| 5883 | tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on |
| 5884 | another protocol or access method. |
| 5885 | |
| 5886 | The table will contain the real server that processed the request. |
| 5887 | |
| 5888 | Example : |
| 5889 | # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity. |
| 5890 | backend https |
| 5891 | mode tcp |
| 5892 | balance roundrobin |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5893 | # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes. |
Emeric Brun | 6a1cefa | 2010-09-24 18:15:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5894 | stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5895 | |
Emeric Brun | 6a1cefa | 2010-09-24 18:15:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5896 | acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1 |
| 5897 | acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2 |
| 5898 | |
| 5899 | # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello. |
| 5900 | tcp-request inspect-delay 5s |
| 5901 | tcp-request content accept if clienthello |
| 5902 | |
| 5903 | # no timeout on response inspect delay by default. |
| 5904 | tcp-response content accept if serverhello |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5905 | |
Emeric Brun | 6a1cefa | 2010-09-24 18:15:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5906 | # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello. |
| 5907 | # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts |
| 5908 | # at offset 44. |
| 5909 | |
| 5910 | # Match and learn on request if client hello. |
| 5911 | stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello |
| 5912 | |
| 5913 | # Learn on response if server hello. |
| 5914 | stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5915 | |
Emeric Brun | 6a1cefa | 2010-09-24 18:15:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5916 | server s1 192.168.1.1:443 |
| 5917 | server s2 192.168.1.1:443 |
| 5918 | |
| 5919 | See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern |
| 5920 | extraction. |
| 5921 | |
| 5922 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5923 | tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>] |
| 5924 | Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition |
Willy Tarreau | 1a68794 | 2010-05-23 22:40:30 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5925 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 5926 | no | yes | yes | no |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5927 | Arguments : |
| 5928 | <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid |
| 5929 | actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2". |
| 5930 | See below for more details. |
Willy Tarreau | 1a68794 | 2010-05-23 22:40:30 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5931 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5932 | <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7). |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5933 | |
| 5934 | Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to |
| 5935 | evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5936 | or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of |
| 5937 | any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the |
| 5938 | buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly |
| 5939 | accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If |
| 5940 | some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the |
| 5941 | "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead. |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5942 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5943 | The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration |
| 5944 | order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to |
| 5945 | accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of |
| 5946 | rules which may be inserted. |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5947 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5948 | Three types of actions are supported : |
| 5949 | - accept : |
| 5950 | accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if") |
| 5951 | or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends |
| 5952 | the rules evaluation. |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5953 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5954 | - reject : |
| 5955 | rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if") |
| 5956 | or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends |
| 5957 | the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a |
| 5958 | session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, |
| 5959 | as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session |
| 5960 | rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules |
| 5961 | should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as |
| 5962 | the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme |
| 5963 | conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the |
| 5964 | system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If |
| 5965 | logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should |
| 5966 | be used instead. |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5967 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5968 | - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] : |
| 5969 | enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These |
| 5970 | rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets |
| 5971 | of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The |
| 5972 | first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the |
| 5973 | specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed |
| 5974 | enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second |
| 5975 | set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for |
| 5976 | the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones. |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5977 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5978 | These actions take one or two arguments : |
| 5979 | <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will |
| 5980 | be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With |
| 5981 | it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address. |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5982 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5983 | <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, |
| 5984 | which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All |
| 5985 | the counters for the matches and updates for the key will |
| 5986 | then be performed in that table until the session ends. |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5987 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5988 | Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table |
| 5989 | and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to |
| 5990 | that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's |
| 5991 | counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's |
| 5992 | counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends. |
| 5993 | If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is |
| 5994 | counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not |
| 5995 | expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance |
| 5996 | advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is |
| 5997 | performed for all ACL checks that make use of it. |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5998 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 5999 | Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on |
| 6000 | the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for |
| 6001 | "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject. |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6002 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6003 | Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast |
| 6004 | connection without counting them, and track accepted connections. |
| 6005 | This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources. |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6006 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6007 | tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst } |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6008 | tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 } |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6009 | tcp-request connection track-sc1 src |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6010 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6011 | Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other |
| 6012 | connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones |
| 6013 | being blocked as long as they don't slow down. |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6014 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6015 | tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst } |
| 6016 | tcp-request connection track-sc1 src |
| 6017 | tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 } |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6018 | |
| 6019 | See section 7 about ACL usage. |
| 6020 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6021 | See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table" |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6022 | |
| 6023 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6024 | tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>] |
| 6025 | Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6026 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
Willy Tarreau | fb35620 | 2010-08-03 14:02:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6027 | no | yes | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6028 | Arguments : |
| 6029 | <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid |
| 6030 | actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2". |
| 6031 | See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification. |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6032 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6033 | <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7). |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6034 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6035 | A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing |
| 6036 | called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are |
| 6037 | evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an |
| 6038 | "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay |
| 6039 | expires with no matching rule. |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6040 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6041 | The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules |
| 6042 | is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a |
| 6043 | decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or |
| 6044 | validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in |
| 6045 | both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new |
| 6046 | connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned |
| 6047 | a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated |
| 6048 | several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned |
| 6049 | (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request). |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6050 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6051 | Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no |
| 6052 | rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the |
| 6053 | contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be |
| 6054 | inserted. |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6055 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6056 | Three types of actions are supported : |
| 6057 | - accept : |
| 6058 | - reject : |
| 6059 | - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6060 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6061 | They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection" |
| 6062 | so please refer to that section for a complete description. |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6063 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6064 | Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule |
| 6065 | defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session |
| 6066 | releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case |
| 6067 | of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing |
| 6068 | mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track |
| 6069 | per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters. |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6070 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6071 | Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6072 | the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for |
| 6073 | "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject. |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6074 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6075 | It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content" |
Willy Tarreau | c0239e0 | 2012-04-16 14:42:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6076 | rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the |
| 6077 | contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered |
| 6078 | contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match. |
| 6079 | The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP |
| 6080 | processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6081 | |
| 6082 | Example: |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6083 | # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com" |
| 6084 | # and reject everything else. |
| 6085 | acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com |
| 6086 | tcp-request inspect-delay 30s |
Willy Tarreau | c0239e0 | 2012-04-16 14:42:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6087 | tcp-request content accept if is_host_com |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6088 | tcp-request content reject |
| 6089 | |
| 6090 | Example: |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6091 | # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first |
| 6092 | tcp-request inspect-delay 30s |
| 6093 | acl content_present req_len gt 0 |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6094 | tcp-request content reject if content_present |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6095 | |
| 6096 | # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks |
| 6097 | tcp-request inspect-delay 30s |
| 6098 | acl content_present req_len gt 0 |
Willy Tarreau | 68c03ab | 2010-08-06 15:08:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6099 | tcp-request content accept if content_present |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6100 | tcp-request content reject |
| 6101 | |
| 6102 | Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the |
| 6103 | frontend when the backend detects abuse. |
| 6104 | |
| 6105 | frontend http |
| 6106 | # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter |
| 6107 | # protecting all our sites |
| 6108 | stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0 |
| 6109 | tcp-request connection track-sc1 src |
| 6110 | tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 } |
| 6111 | ... |
| 6112 | use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php } |
| 6113 | |
| 6114 | backend http_dynamic |
| 6115 | # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked |
| 6116 | # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend. |
| 6117 | stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s) |
| 6118 | acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10 |
| 6119 | acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0 |
| 6120 | tcp-request content track-sc2 src |
| 6121 | tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6122 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6123 | See section 7 about ACL usage. |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6124 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6125 | See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay" |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6126 | |
| 6127 | |
| 6128 | tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout> |
| 6129 | Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection |
| 6130 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
Willy Tarreau | fb35620 | 2010-08-03 14:02:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6131 | no | yes | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6132 | Arguments : |
| 6133 | <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but |
| 6134 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 6135 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 6136 | |
| 6137 | People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the |
| 6138 | risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In |
| 6139 | order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold |
| 6140 | the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of |
| 6141 | data for at most the specified amount of time. |
| 6142 | |
Willy Tarreau | fb35620 | 2010-08-03 14:02:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6143 | TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a |
| 6144 | frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This |
| 6145 | means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a |
| 6146 | second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules. |
| 6147 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6148 | Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole |
| 6149 | rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6150 | those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay, |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6151 | a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the |
Willy Tarreau | d869b24 | 2009-03-15 14:43:58 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6152 | contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all |
| 6153 | and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information. |
| 6154 | Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such |
| 6155 | setups are not recommended. |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6156 | |
| 6157 | As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If |
| 6158 | the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let |
| 6159 | it pass through unaffected. |
| 6160 | |
| 6161 | For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients |
| 6162 | send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to |
| 6163 | cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6164 | to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6165 | before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing |
| 6166 | data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at |
Willy Tarreau | b824b00 | 2010-09-29 16:36:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6167 | least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client |
| 6168 | closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires |
| 6169 | since the contents will not be able to change anymore. |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6170 | |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6171 | See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject", |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6172 | "timeout client". |
| 6173 | |
| 6174 | |
Emeric Brun | 0a3b67f | 2010-09-24 15:34:53 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6175 | tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>] |
| 6176 | Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition |
| 6177 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6178 | no | no | yes | yes |
| 6179 | Arguments : |
| 6180 | <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid |
| 6181 | actions include : "accept", "reject". |
| 6182 | See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification. |
| 6183 | |
| 6184 | <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7). |
| 6185 | |
| 6186 | Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing |
| 6187 | called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are |
| 6188 | evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an |
| 6189 | "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6190 | set and expires with no matching rule. |
Emeric Brun | 0a3b67f | 2010-09-24 15:34:53 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6191 | |
| 6192 | Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity. |
| 6193 | |
| 6194 | Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no |
| 6195 | rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the |
| 6196 | contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be |
| 6197 | inserted. |
| 6198 | |
| 6199 | Two types of actions are supported : |
| 6200 | - accept : |
| 6201 | accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if") |
| 6202 | or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends |
| 6203 | the rules evaluation. |
| 6204 | |
| 6205 | - reject : |
| 6206 | rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if") |
| 6207 | or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends |
Jamie Gloudon | aaa2100 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 6208 | the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed. |
Emeric Brun | 0a3b67f | 2010-09-24 15:34:53 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6209 | |
| 6210 | Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on |
| 6211 | the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for |
| 6212 | for changing the default action to a reject. |
| 6213 | |
Jamie Gloudon | aaa2100 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 6214 | It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response |
| 6215 | content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has |
| 6216 | been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, |
| 6217 | the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection |
Emeric Brun | 0a3b67f | 2010-09-24 15:34:53 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6218 | period. |
| 6219 | |
| 6220 | See section 7 about ACL usage. |
| 6221 | |
| 6222 | See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay" |
| 6223 | |
| 6224 | |
| 6225 | tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout> |
| 6226 | Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection |
| 6227 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6228 | no | no | yes | yes |
| 6229 | Arguments : |
| 6230 | <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but |
| 6231 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 6232 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 6233 | |
| 6234 | See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay". |
| 6235 | |
| 6236 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 5259dfe | 2008-01-21 01:54:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6237 | timeout check <timeout> |
| 6238 | Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already |
| 6239 | established. |
| 6240 | |
| 6241 | May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6242 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 6243 | Arguments: |
| 6244 | <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but |
| 6245 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 6246 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 6247 | |
| 6248 | If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout |
| 6249 | for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is |
| 6250 | used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those |
| 6251 | who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks. |
Willy Tarreau | d7550a2 | 2010-02-10 05:10:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6252 | (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect |
| 6253 | timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to |
| 6254 | avoid that). |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 5259dfe | 2008-01-21 01:54:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6255 | |
| 6256 | If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check |
| 6257 | timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version. |
| 6258 | |
| 6259 | In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal |
| 6260 | requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should |
Willy Tarreau | 41a340d | 2008-01-22 12:25:31 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6261 | be smaller than "timeout server". |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 5259dfe | 2008-01-21 01:54:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6262 | |
| 6263 | This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in |
| 6264 | "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to |
| 6265 | forget about it. |
| 6266 | |
Willy Tarreau | 41a340d | 2008-01-22 12:25:31 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6267 | See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server", |
| 6268 | "timeout tarpit". |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 5259dfe | 2008-01-21 01:54:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6269 | |
| 6270 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6271 | timeout client <timeout> |
| 6272 | timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated) |
| 6273 | Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side. |
| 6274 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6275 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 6276 | Arguments : |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6277 | <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6278 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 6279 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 6280 | |
| 6281 | The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or |
| 6282 | send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider |
| 6283 | during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the |
| 6284 | response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified |
| 6285 | in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is |
| 6286 | suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode |
| 6287 | (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the |
| 6288 | client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6289 | situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6290 | losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds |
Willy Tarreau | ce887fd | 2012-05-12 12:50:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6291 | (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived |
| 6292 | sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel", |
| 6293 | which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6294 | |
| 6295 | This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in |
| 6296 | "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to |
| 6297 | forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which |
| 6298 | is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning |
| 6299 | during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in |
| 6300 | the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either. |
| 6301 | |
| 6302 | This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended |
| 6303 | to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is |
| 6304 | provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged. |
| 6305 | |
Willy Tarreau | ce887fd | 2012-05-12 12:50:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6306 | See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel". |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6307 | |
| 6308 | |
| 6309 | timeout connect <timeout> |
| 6310 | timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated) |
| 6311 | Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed. |
| 6312 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6313 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 6314 | Arguments : |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6315 | <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6316 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 6317 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 6318 | |
| 6319 | If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6320 | immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6321 | cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6322 | slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 5259dfe | 2008-01-21 01:54:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6323 | connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value |
| 6324 | if these have not been specified. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6325 | |
| 6326 | This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in |
| 6327 | "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to |
| 6328 | forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which |
| 6329 | is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning |
| 6330 | during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in |
| 6331 | the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either. |
| 6332 | |
| 6333 | This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended |
| 6334 | to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is |
| 6335 | provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged. |
| 6336 | |
Willy Tarreau | 41a340d | 2008-01-22 12:25:31 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6337 | See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout", |
| 6338 | "timeout tarpit". |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6339 | |
| 6340 | |
Willy Tarreau | b16a574 | 2010-01-10 14:46:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6341 | timeout http-keep-alive <timeout> |
| 6342 | Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear |
| 6343 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6344 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 6345 | Arguments : |
| 6346 | <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but |
| 6347 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 6348 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 6349 | |
| 6350 | By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set |
| 6351 | by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some |
| 6352 | people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections |
| 6353 | faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts |
| 6354 | once the request has started to present itself. |
| 6355 | |
| 6356 | The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to |
| 6357 | wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once |
| 6358 | the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used |
| 6359 | to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a |
| 6360 | new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request. |
| 6361 | |
| 6362 | There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection |
| 6363 | expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection |
| 6364 | just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a |
| 6365 | connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned. |
| 6366 | |
| 6367 | In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of |
| 6368 | milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but |
| 6369 | without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg: |
| 6370 | 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the |
| 6371 | non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running |
Patrick Mézard | 2382ad6 | 2010-05-09 10:43:32 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6372 | with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients. |
Willy Tarreau | b16a574 | 2010-01-10 14:46:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6373 | |
| 6374 | If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both |
| 6375 | are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be |
| 6376 | set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in |
| 6377 | which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used. |
| 6378 | |
| 6379 | See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client". |
| 6380 | |
| 6381 | |
Willy Tarreau | 036fae0 | 2008-01-06 13:24:40 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6382 | timeout http-request <timeout> |
| 6383 | Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request |
| 6384 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
Willy Tarreau | cd7afc0 | 2009-07-12 10:03:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6385 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | 036fae0 | 2008-01-06 13:24:40 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6386 | Arguments : |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6387 | <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but |
Willy Tarreau | 036fae0 | 2008-01-06 13:24:40 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6388 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 6389 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 6390 | |
| 6391 | In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum |
| 6392 | accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client |
| 6393 | timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which |
| 6394 | nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against |
| 6395 | this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the |
| 6396 | attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not |
| 6397 | trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client |
| 6398 | types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. |
| 6399 | |
| 6400 | Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and |
| 6401 | not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not |
Willy Tarreau | b16a574 | 2010-01-10 14:46:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6402 | used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second |
| 6403 | request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set. |
Willy Tarreau | 036fae0 | 2008-01-06 13:24:40 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6404 | |
| 6405 | Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the |
| 6406 | full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP |
| 6407 | retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will |
| 6408 | generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This |
| 6409 | will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet. |
| 6410 | |
| 6411 | If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each |
Willy Tarreau | cd7afc0 | 2009-07-12 10:03:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6412 | chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take |
| 6413 | effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's |
| 6414 | timeout will be used. |
Willy Tarreau | 036fae0 | 2008-01-06 13:24:40 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6415 | |
Willy Tarreau | b16a574 | 2010-01-10 14:46:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6416 | See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client". |
Willy Tarreau | 036fae0 | 2008-01-06 13:24:40 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6417 | |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6418 | |
| 6419 | timeout queue <timeout> |
| 6420 | Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free |
| 6421 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6422 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 6423 | Arguments : |
| 6424 | <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but |
| 6425 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 6426 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 6427 | |
| 6428 | When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue |
| 6429 | which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait |
| 6430 | indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the |
| 6431 | timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be |
| 6432 | served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client. |
| 6433 | |
| 6434 | The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to |
| 6435 | be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's |
| 6436 | connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility |
| 6437 | with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter. |
| 6438 | |
| 6439 | See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout". |
| 6440 | |
| 6441 | |
| 6442 | timeout server <timeout> |
| 6443 | timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated) |
| 6444 | Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side. |
| 6445 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6446 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 6447 | Arguments : |
| 6448 | <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but |
| 6449 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 6450 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 6451 | |
| 6452 | The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or |
| 6453 | send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider |
| 6454 | during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the |
| 6455 | headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the |
| 6456 | request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with |
| 6457 | what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs |
| 6458 | to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly. |
| 6459 | |
| 6460 | The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other |
| 6461 | unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this |
| 6462 | document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly |
| 6463 | recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in |
| 6464 | order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6465 | response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6466 | packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 |
Willy Tarreau | ce887fd | 2012-05-12 12:50:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6467 | seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed |
| 6468 | with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering |
| 6469 | "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for |
| 6470 | tunnels. |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6471 | |
| 6472 | This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in |
| 6473 | "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to |
| 6474 | forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which |
| 6475 | is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning |
| 6476 | during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in |
| 6477 | the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either. |
| 6478 | |
| 6479 | This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended |
| 6480 | to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is |
| 6481 | provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged. |
| 6482 | |
Willy Tarreau | ce887fd | 2012-05-12 12:50:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6483 | See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel". |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6484 | |
| 6485 | |
| 6486 | timeout tarpit <timeout> |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6487 | Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6488 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6489 | yes | yes | yes | yes |
| 6490 | Arguments : |
| 6491 | <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but |
| 6492 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 6493 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 6494 | |
| 6495 | When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with |
| 6496 | no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" |
| 6497 | defines how long it will be maintained open. |
| 6498 | |
| 6499 | The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other |
| 6500 | unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this |
| 6501 | document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout |
| 6502 | ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6503 | with no "timeout tarpit" parameter. |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6504 | |
| 6505 | See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout". |
| 6506 | |
| 6507 | |
Willy Tarreau | ce887fd | 2012-05-12 12:50:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6508 | timeout tunnel <timeout> |
| 6509 | Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels. |
| 6510 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6511 | yes | no | yes | yes |
| 6512 | Arguments : |
| 6513 | <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but |
| 6514 | can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, |
| 6515 | as explained at the top of this document. |
| 6516 | |
Jamie Gloudon | aaa2100 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 6517 | The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established |
Willy Tarreau | ce887fd | 2012-05-12 12:50:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6518 | between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both |
| 6519 | directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once |
| 6520 | the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no |
| 6521 | analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are |
| 6522 | accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg: |
| 6523 | when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request |
| 6524 | to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is |
| 6525 | specified. |
| 6526 | |
| 6527 | The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other |
| 6528 | unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this |
| 6529 | document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to |
| 6530 | cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that |
| 6531 | are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). |
| 6532 | |
| 6533 | This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in |
| 6534 | "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to |
| 6535 | forget about it. |
| 6536 | |
| 6537 | Example : |
| 6538 | defaults http |
| 6539 | option http-server-close |
| 6540 | timeout connect 5s |
| 6541 | timeout client 30s |
| 6542 | timeout client 30s |
| 6543 | timeout server 30s |
| 6544 | timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT |
| 6545 | |
| 6546 | See also : "timeout client", "timeout server". |
| 6547 | |
| 6548 | |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6549 | transparent (deprecated) |
| 6550 | Enable client-side transparent proxying |
| 6551 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
Willy Tarreau | 4b1f859 | 2008-12-23 23:13:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6552 | yes | no | yes | yes |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6553 | Arguments : none |
| 6554 | |
| 6555 | This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer |
| 6556 | 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming |
| 6557 | connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let |
| 6558 | this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is |
| 6559 | used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination |
| 6560 | IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another |
| 6561 | equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the |
| 6562 | appropriate server. |
| 6563 | |
| 6564 | The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead. |
| 6565 | |
| 6566 | Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy |
| 6567 | present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection. |
| 6568 | |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6569 | See also: "option transparent" |
| 6570 | |
William Lallemand | a73203e | 2012-03-12 12:48:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6571 | unique-id-format <string> |
| 6572 | Generate a unique ID for each request. |
| 6573 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6574 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 6575 | Arguments : |
| 6576 | <string> is a log-format string. |
| 6577 | |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6578 | This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A |
| 6579 | unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of |
| 6580 | a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the |
| 6581 | %ID tag the log-format string. |
William Lallemand | a73203e | 2012-03-12 12:48:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6582 | |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6583 | The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be |
| 6584 | unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances |
| 6585 | are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often |
| 6586 | needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses |
| 6587 | and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same |
| 6588 | connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them. |
| 6589 | Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter. |
| 6590 | Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart. |
William Lallemand | a73203e | 2012-03-12 12:48:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6591 | |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6592 | It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it |
| 6593 | makes them more compact and saves space in logs. |
William Lallemand | a73203e | 2012-03-12 12:48:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6594 | |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6595 | Example: |
William Lallemand | a73203e | 2012-03-12 12:48:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6596 | |
| 6597 | unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid |
| 6598 | |
| 6599 | will generate: |
| 6600 | |
| 6601 | 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A |
| 6602 | |
| 6603 | See also: "unique-id-header" |
| 6604 | |
| 6605 | unique-id-header <name> |
| 6606 | Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request. |
| 6607 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6608 | yes | yes | yes | no |
| 6609 | Arguments : |
| 6610 | <name> is the name of the header. |
| 6611 | |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6612 | Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the |
| 6613 | unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist. |
William Lallemand | a73203e | 2012-03-12 12:48:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6614 | |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6615 | Example: |
William Lallemand | a73203e | 2012-03-12 12:48:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6616 | |
| 6617 | unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid |
| 6618 | unique-id-header X-Unique-ID |
| 6619 | |
| 6620 | will generate: |
| 6621 | |
| 6622 | X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A |
| 6623 | |
| 6624 | See also: "unique-id-format" |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6625 | |
| 6626 | use_backend <backend> if <condition> |
| 6627 | use_backend <backend> unless <condition> |
Willy Tarreau | 1d0dfb1 | 2009-07-07 15:10:31 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6628 | Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched. |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6629 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6630 | no | yes | yes | no |
| 6631 | Arguments : |
| 6632 | <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section. |
| 6633 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6634 | <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6635 | |
| 6636 | When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then |
| 6637 | dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The |
| 6638 | relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the |
Willy Tarreau | 1d0dfb1 | 2009-07-07 15:10:31 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6639 | "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can |
| 6640 | also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg: |
| 6641 | source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for |
| 6642 | some payload. |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6643 | |
| 6644 | There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are |
| 6645 | evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will |
| 6646 | assign the backend. |
| 6647 | |
| 6648 | In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the |
| 6649 | second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no |
| 6650 | condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used. |
| 6651 | If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are |
| 6652 | used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is |
| 6653 | used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned. |
| 6654 | |
Willy Tarreau | 51aecc7 | 2009-07-12 09:47:04 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6655 | Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6656 | this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP, |
Willy Tarreau | 51aecc7 | 2009-07-12 09:47:04 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6657 | and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for |
| 6658 | a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend |
| 6659 | must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP. |
| 6660 | |
Willy Tarreau | 1d0dfb1 | 2009-07-07 15:10:31 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6661 | See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs. |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6662 | |
Willy Tarreau | 036fae0 | 2008-01-06 13:24:40 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 6663 | |
Willy Tarreau | 4a5cade | 2012-04-05 21:09:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6664 | use-server <server> if <condition> |
| 6665 | use-server <server> unless <condition> |
| 6666 | Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched. |
| 6667 | May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend |
| 6668 | no | no | yes | yes |
| 6669 | Arguments : |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6670 | <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section. |
Willy Tarreau | 4a5cade | 2012-04-05 21:09:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6671 | |
| 6672 | <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. |
| 6673 | |
| 6674 | By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across |
| 6675 | the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a |
| 6676 | persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request. |
| 6677 | |
| 6678 | Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific |
| 6679 | server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This |
| 6680 | can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after |
| 6681 | the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence |
| 6682 | on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these |
| 6683 | rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which |
| 6684 | matches will assign the server. |
| 6685 | |
| 6686 | If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used |
| 6687 | and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on |
| 6688 | with the next rules until one matches. |
| 6689 | |
| 6690 | In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the |
| 6691 | second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no |
| 6692 | condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned |
| 6693 | according to other persistence mechanisms. |
| 6694 | |
| 6695 | Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but |
| 6696 | does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix |
| 6697 | stripped. |
| 6698 | |
| 6699 | The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it |
| 6700 | suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could |
| 6701 | be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers |
| 6702 | have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic. |
| 6703 | |
| 6704 | Example : |
| 6705 | # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field |
| 6706 | use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com } |
| 6707 | server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0 |
| 6708 | use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com } |
| 6709 | server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0 |
| 6710 | use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com } |
| 6711 | server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0 |
| 6712 | # all the rest is forwarded to this server |
| 6713 | server default 192.168.0.2:443 check |
| 6714 | |
| 6715 | See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs. |
| 6716 | |
Willy Tarreau | b6205fd | 2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6717 | |
| 6718 | 5. Bind and Server options |
| 6719 | -------------------------- |
| 6720 | |
| 6721 | The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings |
| 6722 | depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These |
| 6723 | settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value, |
| 6724 | written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are |
| 6725 | described in this section. |
| 6726 | |
| 6727 | |
| 6728 | 5.1. Bind options |
| 6729 | ----------------- |
| 6730 | |
| 6731 | The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed |
| 6732 | as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes |
| 6733 | no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these |
| 6734 | parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans), |
| 6735 | while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be |
| 6736 | provided immediately after the setting name. |
| 6737 | |
| 6738 | The currently supported settings are the following ones. |
| 6739 | |
| 6740 | accept-proxy |
| 6741 | Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of |
| 6742 | the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer |
| 6743 | 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is |
| 6744 | used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will |
| 6745 | only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses |
| 6746 | indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real |
| 6747 | address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external |
| 6748 | components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the |
| 6749 | X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always |
| 6750 | usable. |
| 6751 | |
| 6752 | backlog <backlog> |
| 6753 | Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's |
| 6754 | backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value. |
| 6755 | |
Emeric Brun | 7fb3442 | 2012-09-28 15:26:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6756 | ecdhe <named curve> |
| 6757 | This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets |
| 6758 | the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys and makes |
| 6759 | ECDHE cipher suites usable. |
| 6760 | |
Emeric Brun | 1a073b4 | 2012-09-28 17:07:34 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6761 | cafile <cafile> |
| 6762 | This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It |
| 6763 | designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify |
| 6764 | client's certificate. |
| 6765 | |
Emeric Brun | b6dc934 | 2012-09-28 17:55:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6766 | ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...] |
| 6767 | This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. |
| 6768 | Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0. |
| 6769 | If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an |
| 6770 | error is ignored. |
| 6771 | |
Willy Tarreau | b6205fd | 2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6772 | ciphers <ciphers> |
| 6773 | This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets |
| 6774 | the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are |
| 6775 | negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined |
| 6776 | in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string |
| 6777 | such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). |
| 6778 | |
Emeric Brun | 1a073b4 | 2012-09-28 17:07:34 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6779 | crlfile <cafile> |
| 6780 | This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It |
| 6781 | designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used |
| 6782 | to verify client's certificate. |
| 6783 | |
Willy Tarreau | b6205fd | 2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6784 | crt <cert> |
| 6785 | This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. |
| 6786 | It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the |
| 6787 | associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM |
Emeric Brun | e032bfa | 2012-09-28 13:01:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6788 | files into one. If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters |
| 6789 | present in this file are also loaded. If a directory name is used instead of a |
| 6790 | PEM file, then all files found in that directory will be loaded. This |
| 6791 | directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from |
| 6792 | multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients |
| 6793 | who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN |
| 6794 | or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is |
| 6795 | used instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches |
Willy Tarreau | b6205fd | 2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6796 | www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If no SNI is provided by the |
Emeric Brun | e032bfa | 2012-09-28 13:01:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6797 | client or if the SSL library does not support TLS extensions, or if the client |
| 6798 | provides and SNI which does not match any certificate, then the first loaded |
| 6799 | certificate will be presented. This means that when loading certificates from |
| 6800 | a directory, it is highly recommended to load the default one first as a file. |
| 6801 | Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects. |
Willy Tarreau | b6205fd | 2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6802 | |
Emeric Brun | b6dc934 | 2012-09-28 17:55:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6803 | crt-ignore-err <errors> |
| 6804 | This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. |
| 6805 | Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. |
| 6806 | If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an |
| 6807 | error is ignored. |
| 6808 | |
Willy Tarreau | b6205fd | 2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6809 | defer-accept |
| 6810 | Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It |
| 6811 | states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it, |
| 6812 | or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols |
| 6813 | for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve |
| 6814 | performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when |
| 6815 | the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect |
| 6816 | connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is |
| 6817 | broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until |
| 6818 | the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see |
| 6819 | an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This |
| 6820 | option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. |
| 6821 | |
Emeric Brun | 2cb7ae5 | 2012-10-05 14:14:21 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6822 | force-sslv3 |
| 6823 | This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from |
| 6824 | this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts |
| 6825 | for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*". |
| 6826 | |
| 6827 | force-tlsv10 |
| 6828 | This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from |
| 6829 | this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*". |
| 6830 | |
| 6831 | force-tlsv11 |
| 6832 | This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from |
| 6833 | this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*". |
| 6834 | |
| 6835 | force-tlsv12 |
| 6836 | This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from |
| 6837 | this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*". |
| 6838 | |
Willy Tarreau | b6205fd | 2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6839 | gid <gid> |
| 6840 | Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also |
| 6841 | be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that |
| 6842 | some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group" |
| 6843 | setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is |
| 6844 | ignored by non UNIX sockets. |
| 6845 | |
| 6846 | group <group> |
| 6847 | Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can |
| 6848 | also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note |
| 6849 | that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the |
| 6850 | "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This |
| 6851 | setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets. |
| 6852 | |
| 6853 | id <id> |
| 6854 | Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but |
| 6855 | sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value |
| 6856 | must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This |
| 6857 | option can only be used when defining only a single socket. |
| 6858 | |
| 6859 | interface <interface> |
| 6860 | Sets the name of the network interface to listen. This is currently only |
| 6861 | supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system interface, not an |
| 6862 | aliased interface. When specified, all addresses on the same line will only |
| 6863 | be accepted if the incoming packets physically come through the designated |
| 6864 | interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to the same address |
| 6865 | if they are bound to different interfaces. Note that binding to a network |
| 6866 | interface requires root privileges. This parameter is only compatible with |
| 6867 | TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. |
| 6868 | |
Willy Tarreau | abb175f | 2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6869 | level <level> |
| 6870 | This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of |
| 6871 | the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other |
| 6872 | sockets. <level> can be one of : |
| 6873 | - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be |
| 6874 | read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it |
| 6875 | is not easy to restrict access to the socket. |
| 6876 | - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can |
| 6877 | be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max |
| 6878 | counters). |
| 6879 | - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear |
| 6880 | all counters). |
| 6881 | |
Willy Tarreau | b6205fd | 2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6882 | maxconn <maxconn> |
| 6883 | Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous |
| 6884 | connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is |
| 6885 | released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's |
| 6886 | maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same |
| 6887 | value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different |
| 6888 | limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily |
| 6889 | eat all memory. |
| 6890 | |
| 6891 | mode <mode> |
| 6892 | Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It |
| 6893 | can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. |
| 6894 | Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non |
| 6895 | UNIX sockets. |
| 6896 | |
| 6897 | mss <maxseg> |
| 6898 | Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming |
| 6899 | connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific |
| 6900 | ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this |
| 6901 | relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but |
| 6902 | was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other |
| 6903 | operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the |
| 6904 | effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4 |
| 6905 | over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is |
| 6906 | positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will |
| 6907 | indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for |
| 6908 | outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets. |
| 6909 | |
| 6910 | name <name> |
| 6911 | Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats |
| 6912 | page. |
| 6913 | |
| 6914 | nice <nice> |
| 6915 | Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be |
| 6916 | in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values |
| 6917 | means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer |
| 6918 | their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that |
| 6919 | connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference |
| 6920 | only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation. |
| 6921 | Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services, |
| 6922 | and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL |
| 6923 | processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example, |
| 6924 | it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative |
| 6925 | one for an RDP socket. |
| 6926 | |
Emeric Brun | 9b3009b | 2012-10-05 11:55:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6927 | no-sslv3 |
Willy Tarreau | b6205fd | 2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6928 | This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It |
| 6929 | disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when |
| 6930 | SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot |
Emeric Brun | 2cb7ae5 | 2012-10-05 14:14:21 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6931 | be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*", |
| 6932 | and "force-sslv3". |
Willy Tarreau | b6205fd | 2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6933 | |
Emeric Brun | 90ad872 | 2012-10-02 14:00:59 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6934 | no-tls-tickets |
| 6935 | This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It |
| 6936 | disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket |
| 6937 | extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless |
| 6938 | session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. |
| 6939 | |
Emeric Brun | 9b3009b | 2012-10-05 11:55:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6940 | no-tlsv10 |
Willy Tarreau | b6205fd | 2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6941 | This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It |
Emeric Brun | 2cb7ae5 | 2012-10-05 14:14:21 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6942 | disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener |
| 6943 | when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and |
| 6944 | cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*", |
| 6945 | and "force-sslv3". |
Willy Tarreau | b6205fd | 2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6946 | |
Emeric Brun | 9b3009b | 2012-10-05 11:55:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6947 | no-tlsv11 |
Emeric Brun | f5da493 | 2012-09-28 19:42:54 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6948 | This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It |
Emeric Brun | 2cb7ae5 | 2012-10-05 14:14:21 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6949 | disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener |
| 6950 | when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and |
| 6951 | cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*", |
| 6952 | and "force-sslv3". |
Emeric Brun | f5da493 | 2012-09-28 19:42:54 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6953 | |
Emeric Brun | 9b3009b | 2012-10-05 11:55:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6954 | no-tlsv12 |
Emeric Brun | f5da493 | 2012-09-28 19:42:54 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6955 | This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It |
Emeric Brun | 2cb7ae5 | 2012-10-05 14:14:21 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6956 | disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener |
| 6957 | when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and |
| 6958 | cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*", |
| 6959 | and "force-sslv3". |
Emeric Brun | f5da493 | 2012-09-28 19:42:54 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6960 | |
Willy Tarreau | b6205fd | 2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6961 | ssl |
| 6962 | This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It |
| 6963 | enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A |
| 6964 | certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will |
| 6965 | appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access |
| 6966 | to deciphered contents. |
| 6967 | |
Willy Tarreau | 1c862c5 | 2012-10-05 16:21:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6968 | tfo |
| 6969 | Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.6. It |
| 6970 | enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which |
| 6971 | support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response |
| 6972 | during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one |
| 6973 | round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols |
| 6974 | that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can |
| 6975 | possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN |
| 6976 | packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option |
| 6977 | is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. |
| 6978 | |
Willy Tarreau | b6205fd | 2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 6979 | transparent |
| 6980 | Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It |
| 6981 | indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the |
| 6982 | local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be |
| 6983 | intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally |
| 6984 | requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the |
| 6985 | default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port. |
| 6986 | This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. |
| 6987 | This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on |
| 6988 | kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature, |
| 6989 | so check for support with your vendor. |
| 6990 | |
| 6991 | uid <uid> |
| 6992 | Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also |
| 6993 | be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that |
| 6994 | some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user" |
| 6995 | setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This |
| 6996 | setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets. |
| 6997 | |
| 6998 | user <user> |
| 6999 | Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also |
| 7000 | be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that |
| 7001 | some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid" |
| 7002 | setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is |
| 7003 | ignored by non UNIX sockets. |
| 7004 | |
Emeric Brun | 1a073b4 | 2012-09-28 17:07:34 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7005 | verify [none|optional|required] |
| 7006 | This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set |
| 7007 | to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other |
| 7008 | cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a |
| 7009 | certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the |
| 7010 | handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The |
| 7011 | certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from 'cafile' |
| 7012 | and optional CRLs from 'crlfile'. On verify failure the handshake is aborted, |
Emeric Brun | b6dc934 | 2012-09-28 17:55:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7013 | regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly matches one |
| 7014 | of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'. |
Willy Tarreau | 4a5cade | 2012-04-05 21:09:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7015 | |
Willy Tarreau | b6205fd | 2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7016 | 5.2. Server and default-server options |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7017 | ------------------------------------ |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7018 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c6df066 | 2010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7019 | The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings |
| 7020 | which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those |
| 7021 | arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those |
| 7022 | settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values |
| 7023 | after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name. |
| 7024 | Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's |
| 7025 | address if they are used: |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7026 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7027 | server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...] |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c6df066 | 2010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7028 | default-server [settings ...] |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7029 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7030 | The currently supported settings are the following ones. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7031 | |
Willy Tarreau | ceb4ac9 | 2012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7032 | addr <ipv4|ipv6> |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7033 | Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address |
| 7034 | to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP |
| 7035 | address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more |
| 7036 | suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if |
| 7037 | the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7038 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7039 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7040 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7041 | backup |
| 7042 | When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load |
| 7043 | balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming |
| 7044 | with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served |
| 7045 | though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless |
| 7046 | the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups" |
| 7047 | option. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7048 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7049 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7050 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7051 | check |
| 7052 | This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is |
Patrick Mézard | b7aeec6 | 2012-01-22 16:01:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7053 | always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when |
| 7054 | accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve |
| 7055 | requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the |
| 7056 | server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the |
| 7057 | backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the |
| 7058 | port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source" |
| 7059 | address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall" |
| 7060 | parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk", |
| 7061 | "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please |
| 7062 | refer to those options and parameters for more information. |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7063 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7064 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7065 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6c16adc | 2012-10-05 00:04:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7066 | check-send-proxy |
| 7067 | This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health |
| 7068 | checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the |
| 7069 | normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks |
| 7070 | if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr" |
| 7071 | directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the |
| 7072 | "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the |
| 7073 | protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information. |
| 7074 | |
| 7075 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7076 | |
Willy Tarreau | 763a95b | 2012-10-04 23:15:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7077 | check-ssl |
| 7078 | This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of |
| 7079 | whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally |
| 7080 | used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health |
| 7081 | checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option |
| 7082 | inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect |
| 7083 | check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most |
| 7084 | common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks. |
| 7085 | All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers). |
| 7086 | See the "ssl" option for more information. |
| 7087 | |
| 7088 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7089 | |
Willy Tarreau | a0ee1d0 | 2012-09-10 09:01:23 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7090 | ciphers <ciphers> |
| 7091 | This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is |
| 7092 | is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the |
| 7093 | string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with |
| 7094 | servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms |
| 7095 | than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the |
| 7096 | server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software. |
| 7097 | Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all |
| 7098 | is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate. |
| 7099 | |
Willy Tarreau | 763a95b | 2012-10-04 23:15:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7100 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7101 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7102 | cookie <value> |
| 7103 | The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to |
| 7104 | <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first |
| 7105 | operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in |
| 7106 | cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie |
| 7107 | sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing |
| 7108 | the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and |
| 7109 | backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section. |
| 7110 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7111 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7112 | |
Willy Tarreau | 9683909 | 2010-03-29 10:02:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7113 | disabled |
| 7114 | The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means |
| 7115 | that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the |
| 7116 | ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup |
| 7117 | new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still |
| 7118 | possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism. |
| 7119 | |
| 7120 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7121 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7122 | error-limit <count> |
Willy Tarreau | 983e01e | 2010-01-11 18:42:06 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7123 | If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the |
| 7124 | number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error" |
| 7125 | option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors. |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 97f07b8 | 2009-12-15 22:31:24 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7126 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7127 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 7128 | |
| 7129 | See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error". |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 97f07b8 | 2009-12-15 22:31:24 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7130 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7131 | fall <count> |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7132 | The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after |
| 7133 | <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if |
| 7134 | unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters. |
| 7135 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7136 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 7137 | |
Emeric Brun | 8694b9a | 2012-10-05 14:39:07 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7138 | force-sslv3 |
| 7139 | This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with |
| 7140 | the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for |
| 7141 | high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3". |
| 7142 | |
| 7143 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7144 | |
| 7145 | force-tlsv10 |
| 7146 | This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with |
| 7147 | the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3". |
| 7148 | |
| 7149 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7150 | |
| 7151 | force-tlsv11 |
| 7152 | This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with |
| 7153 | the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3". |
| 7154 | |
| 7155 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7156 | |
| 7157 | force-tlsv12 |
| 7158 | This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with |
| 7159 | the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3". |
| 7160 | |
| 7161 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7162 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7163 | id <value> |
Willy Tarreau | 53fb4ae | 2009-10-04 23:04:08 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7164 | Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for |
| 7165 | the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first |
| 7166 | assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics. |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7167 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7168 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7169 | |
| 7170 | inter <delay> |
| 7171 | fastinter <delay> |
| 7172 | downinter <delay> |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7173 | The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks |
| 7174 | to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms. |
| 7175 | It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays |
| 7176 | between checks depending on the server state : |
| 7177 | |
| 7178 | Server state | Interval used |
| 7179 | ---------------------------------+----------------------------------------- |
| 7180 | UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter" |
| 7181 | ---------------------------------+----------------------------------------- |
| 7182 | Transitionally UP (going down), | |
| 7183 | Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise. |
| 7184 | or yet unchecked. | |
| 7185 | ---------------------------------+----------------------------------------- |
| 7186 | DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise. |
| 7187 | ---------------------------------+----------------------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7188 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7189 | Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any |
| 7190 | other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also |
| 7191 | serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is |
| 7192 | not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are |
| 7193 | hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started |
| 7194 | with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random |
| 7195 | noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks" |
| 7196 | keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same |
| 7197 | servers. |
| 7198 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7199 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 7200 | |
| 7201 | maxconn <maxconn> |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7202 | The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent |
| 7203 | connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming |
| 7204 | concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting |
| 7205 | for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can |
| 7206 | save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn" |
| 7207 | parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0" |
| 7208 | which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and |
| 7209 | the backend's "fullconn" keyword. |
| 7210 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7211 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 7212 | |
| 7213 | maxqueue <maxqueue> |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7214 | The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which |
| 7215 | will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next |
| 7216 | requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely |
| 7217 | waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to |
| 7218 | quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The |
| 7219 | default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the |
| 7220 | "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters. |
| 7221 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7222 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 7223 | |
| 7224 | minconn <minconn> |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7225 | When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic |
| 7226 | limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least |
| 7227 | <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on |
| 7228 | the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn> |
| 7229 | concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the |
| 7230 | server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7231 | overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn" |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7232 | and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword. |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 97f07b8 | 2009-12-15 22:31:24 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7233 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7234 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 7235 | |
Emeric Brun | 9b3009b | 2012-10-05 11:55:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7236 | no-sslv3 |
Willy Tarreau | a0ee1d0 | 2012-09-10 09:01:23 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7237 | This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with |
| 7238 | the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled |
Emeric Brun | 8694b9a | 2012-10-05 14:39:07 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7239 | using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*". |
Willy Tarreau | a0ee1d0 | 2012-09-10 09:01:23 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7240 | |
Willy Tarreau | 763a95b | 2012-10-04 23:15:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7241 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7242 | |
Emeric Brun | 9b3009b | 2012-10-05 11:55:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7243 | no-tlsv10 |
Emeric Brun | 8694b9a | 2012-10-05 14:39:07 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7244 | This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with |
Emeric Brun | f5da493 | 2012-09-28 19:42:54 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7245 | the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled |
| 7246 | using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it |
Emeric Brun | 8694b9a | 2012-10-05 14:39:07 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7247 | often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See |
| 7248 | also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*". |
Emeric Brun | f5da493 | 2012-09-28 19:42:54 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7249 | |
Willy Tarreau | 763a95b | 2012-10-04 23:15:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7250 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7251 | |
Emeric Brun | 9b3009b | 2012-10-05 11:55:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7252 | no-tlsv11 |
Emeric Brun | 8694b9a | 2012-10-05 14:39:07 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7253 | This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with |
Emeric Brun | f5da493 | 2012-09-28 19:42:54 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7254 | the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled |
| 7255 | using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it |
Emeric Brun | 8694b9a | 2012-10-05 14:39:07 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7256 | often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See |
| 7257 | also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*". |
Emeric Brun | f5da493 | 2012-09-28 19:42:54 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7258 | |
Willy Tarreau | 763a95b | 2012-10-04 23:15:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7259 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7260 | |
Emeric Brun | 9b3009b | 2012-10-05 11:55:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7261 | no-tlsv12 |
Emeric Brun | 8694b9a | 2012-10-05 14:39:07 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7262 | This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with |
Willy Tarreau | a0ee1d0 | 2012-09-10 09:01:23 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7263 | the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled |
| 7264 | using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it |
Emeric Brun | 8694b9a | 2012-10-05 14:39:07 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7265 | often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See |
| 7266 | also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*". |
Willy Tarreau | a0ee1d0 | 2012-09-10 09:01:23 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7267 | |
Willy Tarreau | 763a95b | 2012-10-04 23:15:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7268 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7269 | |
Simon Horman | fa46168 | 2011-06-25 09:39:49 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 7270 | non-stick |
| 7271 | Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table. |
| 7272 | This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that |
| 7273 | stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers. |
| 7274 | |
Willy Tarreau | 763a95b | 2012-10-04 23:15:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7275 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7276 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 97f07b8 | 2009-12-15 22:31:24 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7277 | observe <mode> |
| 7278 | This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with |
| 7279 | the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also |
| 7280 | requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and |
| 7281 | "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are |
| 7282 | significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses |
| 7283 | received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable |
Willy Tarreau | 150d146 | 2012-03-10 08:19:02 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7284 | headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505. |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 97f07b8 | 2009-12-15 22:31:24 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7285 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7286 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7287 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 97f07b8 | 2009-12-15 22:31:24 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7288 | See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit". |
| 7289 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7290 | on-error <mode> |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 97f07b8 | 2009-12-15 22:31:24 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7291 | Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected. |
| 7292 | Currently, four modes are available: |
| 7293 | - fastinter: force fastinter |
| 7294 | - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default) |
| 7295 | - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed |
| 7296 | check will mark a server down, forces fastinter |
| 7297 | - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter |
| 7298 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7299 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 7300 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 97f07b8 | 2009-12-15 22:31:24 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7301 | See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit". |
| 7302 | |
Simon Horman | e0d1bfb | 2011-06-21 14:34:58 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 7303 | on-marked-down <action> |
| 7304 | Modify what occurs when a server is marked down. |
| 7305 | Currently one action is available: |
Justin Karneges | eb2c24a | 2012-05-24 15:28:52 -0700 | [diff] [blame] | 7306 | - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled, |
| 7307 | all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server |
| 7308 | goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases |
| 7309 | than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service |
| 7310 | to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check |
| 7311 | might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse |
| 7312 | existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with |
| 7313 | a 'D' termination code (for "Down"). |
Simon Horman | e0d1bfb | 2011-06-21 14:34:58 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 7314 | |
| 7315 | Actions are disabled by default |
| 7316 | |
| 7317 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 7318 | |
Justin Karneges | eb2c24a | 2012-05-24 15:28:52 -0700 | [diff] [blame] | 7319 | on-marked-up <action> |
| 7320 | Modify what occurs when a server is marked up. |
| 7321 | Currently one action is available: |
| 7322 | - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is |
| 7323 | done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled |
| 7324 | (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force |
| 7325 | an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing |
| 7326 | with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble |
| 7327 | than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature |
| 7328 | with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged |
| 7329 | with an 'U' termination code (for "Up"). |
| 7330 | |
| 7331 | Actions are disabled by default |
| 7332 | |
| 7333 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 7334 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7335 | port <port> |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7336 | Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to |
| 7337 | send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port |
| 7338 | to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable |
| 7339 | to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in |
| 7340 | inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not |
| 7341 | set. See also the "addr" parameter. |
| 7342 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7343 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 7344 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7345 | redir <prefix> |
| 7346 | The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD |
| 7347 | requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy |
| 7348 | forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with |
| 7349 | the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the |
| 7350 | requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means |
| 7351 | that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests |
| 7352 | will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by |
| 7353 | the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7354 | mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7355 | requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct |
| 7356 | users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in |
| 7357 | increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly |
| 7358 | connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a |
| 7359 | loop between the client and HAProxy! |
| 7360 | |
| 7361 | Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check |
| 7362 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7363 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7364 | |
| 7365 | rise <count> |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7366 | The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational |
| 7367 | after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2 |
| 7368 | if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters. |
| 7369 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7370 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 7371 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5ab04ec | 2011-03-20 10:32:26 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7372 | send-proxy |
| 7373 | The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any |
| 7374 | connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other |
| 7375 | end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can |
| 7376 | know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the |
| 7377 | upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener, |
| 7378 | the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families |
| 7379 | are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN |
| 7380 | family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of |
| 7381 | haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be |
Willy Tarreau | 6c16adc | 2012-10-05 00:04:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7382 | used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent |
| 7383 | to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is |
| 7384 | set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an |
| 7385 | explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY |
| 7386 | protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword. |
Willy Tarreau | 5ab04ec | 2011-03-20 10:32:26 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7387 | |
| 7388 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7389 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7390 | slowstart <start_time_in_ms> |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7391 | The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which |
| 7392 | indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at |
| 7393 | full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered |
| 7394 | in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows |
| 7395 | linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two |
| 7396 | parameters : |
| 7397 | |
| 7398 | - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1 |
| 7399 | to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn). |
| 7400 | |
| 7401 | - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight |
| 7402 | grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every |
| 7403 | health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter |
| 7404 | is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps. |
| 7405 | |
| 7406 | The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause |
| 7407 | trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously |
| 7408 | seen as failed. |
| 7409 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7410 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 7411 | |
Willy Tarreau | c6f4ce8 | 2009-06-10 11:09:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7412 | source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ] |
Willy Tarreau | bce7088 | 2009-09-07 11:51:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7413 | source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ] |
Willy Tarreau | c6f4ce8 | 2009-06-10 11:09:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7414 | source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ... |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7415 | The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when |
| 7416 | connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle |
| 7417 | as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server |
| 7418 | referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details. |
| 7419 | |
Willy Tarreau | c6f4ce8 | 2009-06-10 11:09:37 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7420 | Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a |
| 7421 | source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a |
| 7422 | dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a |
| 7423 | source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for |
| 7424 | several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k |
| 7425 | total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per |
| 7426 | server. |
| 7427 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7428 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7429 | |
Willy Tarreau | a0ee1d0 | 2012-09-10 09:01:23 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7430 | ssl |
Willy Tarreau | 763a95b | 2012-10-04 23:15:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7431 | This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At |
| 7432 | the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in |
| 7433 | the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication |
| 7434 | with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would |
| 7435 | otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications. When this |
| 7436 | option is used, health checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there |
| 7437 | is a "port" or an "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a |
| 7438 | different location. See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks. |
| 7439 | |
| 7440 | Supported in default-server: No |
Willy Tarreau | a0ee1d0 | 2012-09-10 09:01:23 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7441 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7442 | track [<proxy>/]<server> |
| 7443 | This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by |
| 7444 | tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked |
| 7445 | so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another |
| 7446 | one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is |
| 7447 | used, it has to be enabled on both proxies. |
| 7448 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7449 | Supported in default-server: No |
| 7450 | |
| 7451 | weight <weight> |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7452 | The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to |
| 7453 | other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight |
| 7454 | relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the |
Willy Tarreau | 6704d67 | 2009-06-15 10:56:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7455 | load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0 |
| 7456 | means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept |
| 7457 | persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load |
| 7458 | according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which |
| 7459 | can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough |
| 7460 | room above and below for later adjustments. |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7461 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | c53601c | 2010-01-06 10:50:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7462 | Supported in default-server: Yes |
| 7463 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7464 | |
| 7465 | 6. HTTP header manipulation |
| 7466 | --------------------------- |
| 7467 | |
| 7468 | In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and |
| 7469 | response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a |
| 7470 | request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression, |
| 7471 | which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect |
| 7472 | against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation |
| 7473 | to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers |
| 7474 | passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent |
| 7475 | headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy |
| 7476 | never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers. |
| 7477 | |
Willy Tarreau | 816b979 | 2009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7478 | There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" |
| 7479 | (status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, |
| 7480 | rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such |
| 7481 | messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers |
| 7482 | in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7483 | happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally |
Willy Tarreau | 816b979 | 2009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7484 | add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, |
| 7485 | normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages. |
| 7486 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7487 | This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail |
| 7488 | in section 4.2 : |
| 7489 | |
| 7490 | - reqadd <string> |
| 7491 | - reqallow <search> |
| 7492 | - reqiallow <search> |
| 7493 | - reqdel <search> |
| 7494 | - reqidel <search> |
| 7495 | - reqdeny <search> |
| 7496 | - reqideny <search> |
| 7497 | - reqpass <search> |
| 7498 | - reqipass <search> |
| 7499 | - reqrep <search> <replace> |
| 7500 | - reqirep <search> <replace> |
| 7501 | - reqtarpit <search> |
| 7502 | - reqitarpit <search> |
| 7503 | - rspadd <string> |
| 7504 | - rspdel <search> |
| 7505 | - rspidel <search> |
| 7506 | - rspdeny <search> |
| 7507 | - rspideny <search> |
| 7508 | - rsprep <search> <replace> |
| 7509 | - rspirep <search> <replace> |
| 7510 | |
| 7511 | With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter |
| 7512 | is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through |
| 7513 | parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be |
| 7514 | prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter. |
| 7515 | Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning : |
| 7516 | |
| 7517 | \t for a tab |
| 7518 | \r for a carriage return (CR) |
| 7519 | \n for a new line (LF) |
| 7520 | \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter |
| 7521 | \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment |
| 7522 | \\ to use a backslash in a regex |
| 7523 | \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy) |
| 7524 | \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language |
| 7525 | |
| 7526 | The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest |
| 7527 | portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters |
| 7528 | above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the |
| 7529 | regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to |
| 7530 | 9 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice |
| 7531 | is very common to users of the "sed" program. |
| 7532 | |
| 7533 | The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added |
| 7534 | after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above. |
| 7535 | |
| 7536 | Notes related to these keywords : |
| 7537 | --------------------------------- |
| 7538 | - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header |
| 7539 | contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword |
| 7540 | instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules. |
| 7541 | |
| 7542 | - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference |
| 7543 | a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way |
| 7544 | headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon). |
| 7545 | |
| 7546 | - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to |
| 7547 | rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes |
| 7548 | it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix |
| 7549 | ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix |
| 7550 | ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon. |
| 7551 | |
| 7552 | - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to |
| 7553 | a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This |
| 7554 | should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short |
| 7555 | on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some |
| 7556 | useless headers before adding new ones. |
| 7557 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7558 | - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7559 | without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns. |
| 7560 | |
| 7561 | - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules |
| 7562 | from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend |
| 7563 | will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses. |
| 7564 | |
| 7565 | - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is |
| 7566 | always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7567 | before switching. |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7568 | |
| 7569 | |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7570 | 7. Using ACLs and pattern extraction |
| 7571 | ------------------------------------ |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7572 | |
| 7573 | The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform |
| 7574 | content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted |
| 7575 | from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is |
| 7576 | simple : |
| 7577 | |
| 7578 | - define test criteria with sets of values |
| 7579 | - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid |
| 7580 | |
| 7581 | The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend. |
| 7582 | |
| 7583 | In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is : |
| 7584 | |
| 7585 | acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ... |
| 7586 | |
| 7587 | This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests. |
| 7588 | Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion> |
| 7589 | and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support |
| 7590 | an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are |
| 7591 | of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces. |
| 7592 | |
| 7593 | ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash), |
| 7594 | '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive, |
| 7595 | which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs. |
| 7596 | |
| 7597 | There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect |
| 7598 | performance, they just consume a small amount of memory. |
| 7599 | |
| 7600 | The following ACL flags are currently supported : |
| 7601 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2b5285d | 2010-05-09 23:45:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7602 | -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns. |
| 7603 | -f : load patterns from a file. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7604 | -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags. |
| 7605 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2b5285d | 2010-05-09 23:45:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7606 | The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file |
| 7607 | specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even |
| 7608 | possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from |
Willy Tarreau | 58215a0 | 2010-05-13 22:07:43 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7609 | multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will |
| 7610 | be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely |
| 7611 | needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a |
| 7612 | space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and |
| 7613 | match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast |
| 7614 | lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case, |
| 7615 | duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies |
Jamie Gloudon | aaa2100 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 7616 | to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For |
Willy Tarreau | 58215a0 | 2010-05-13 22:07:43 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7617 | instance : |
Willy Tarreau | 2b5285d | 2010-05-09 23:45:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7618 | |
| 7619 | acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test |
| 7620 | |
| 7621 | In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against |
| 7622 | the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be |
| 7623 | case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched |
| 7624 | too. |
| 7625 | |
| 7626 | Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if |
| 7627 | a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the |
| 7628 | ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes. |
| 7629 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7630 | Supported types of values are : |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7631 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7632 | - integers or integer ranges |
| 7633 | - strings |
| 7634 | - regular expressions |
| 7635 | - IP addresses and networks |
| 7636 | |
| 7637 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7638 | 7.1. Matching integers |
| 7639 | ---------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7640 | |
| 7641 | Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note |
| 7642 | that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value |
| 7643 | expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which |
| 7644 | may be omitted. |
| 7645 | |
| 7646 | For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of |
| 7647 | unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid |
| 7648 | representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work. |
| 7649 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7650 | As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact |
| 7651 | two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for |
| 7652 | instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including |
| 7653 | ranges and operators. |
| 7654 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7655 | For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7656 | operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged. |
| 7657 | Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set |
| 7658 | of values. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7659 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7660 | Available operators for integer matching are : |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7661 | |
| 7662 | eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value |
| 7663 | ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value |
| 7664 | gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value |
| 7665 | le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value |
| 7666 | lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value |
| 7667 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7668 | For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header : |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7669 | |
| 7670 | acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0 |
| 7671 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7672 | This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) : |
| 7673 | |
| 7674 | acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1 |
| 7675 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7676 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7677 | 7.2. Matching strings |
| 7678 | --------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7679 | |
| 7680 | String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the |
| 7681 | exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some |
| 7682 | characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first |
| 7683 | string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order |
| 7684 | to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7685 | before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--". |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7686 | |
| 7687 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7688 | 7.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes) |
| 7689 | ------------------------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7690 | |
| 7691 | Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as |
| 7692 | they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it |
| 7693 | possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is |
| 7694 | passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring |
| 7695 | the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7696 | the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to |
| 7697 | match the string "--". |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7698 | |
| 7699 | |
Willy Tarreau | ceb4ac9 | 2012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7700 | 7.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7701 | ---------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7702 | |
| 7703 | IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a |
| 7704 | netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is |
| 7705 | within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable |
Willy Tarreau | d2a4aa2 | 2008-01-31 15:28:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7706 | host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7707 | difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should |
| 7708 | at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration |
| 7709 | does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is |
| 7710 | parsed. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7711 | |
Willy Tarreau | ceb4ac9 | 2012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7712 | IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended. |
| 7713 | Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of |
| 7714 | trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in |
| 7715 | IPv6 patterns. |
| 7716 | |
| 7717 | HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the |
| 7718 | following situations : |
| 7719 | - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies |
| 7720 | in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any. |
| 7721 | - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies |
| 7722 | in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any. |
| 7723 | - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4 |
| 7724 | using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::, |
| 7725 | ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails. |
| 7726 | - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first |
| 7727 | converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is |
| 7728 | applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask. |
| 7729 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7730 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7731 | 7.5. Available matching criteria |
| 7732 | -------------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7733 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7734 | 7.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below |
| 7735 | ------------------------------------ |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7736 | |
| 7737 | A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any |
| 7738 | analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP |
Jamie Gloudon | 801a0a3 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 7739 | addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream. |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7740 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7741 | always_false |
| 7742 | This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as |
| 7743 | a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations. |
| 7744 | |
| 7745 | always_true |
| 7746 | This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as |
| 7747 | a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations. |
| 7748 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7749 | avg_queue <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7750 | avg_queue(<backend>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7751 | Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend |
| 7752 | divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue" |
| 7753 | except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more |
| 7754 | accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be |
| 7755 | processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it |
| 7756 | becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event |
| 7757 | there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the |
| 7758 | number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate, |
| 7759 | as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send |
| 7760 | new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue", |
| 7761 | "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria. |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 346f76d | 2010-01-12 21:59:30 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7762 | |
Willy Tarreau | a36af91 | 2009-10-10 12:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7763 | be_conn <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7764 | be_conn(<backend>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | a36af91 | 2009-10-10 12:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7765 | Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend, |
| 7766 | possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is |
| 7767 | specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another |
| 7768 | backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full. |
| 7769 | See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7770 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | 35ed801 | 2010-12-15 14:04:51 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7771 | be_id <integer> |
| 7772 | Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which |
| 7773 | backend it was called. |
| 7774 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7775 | be_sess_rate <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7776 | be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7777 | Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the |
| 7778 | specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is |
| 7779 | used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one |
| 7780 | reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent |
| 7781 | sucking of an online dictionary). |
| 7782 | |
| 7783 | Example : |
| 7784 | # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often |
| 7785 | backend dynamic |
| 7786 | mode http |
| 7787 | acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100 |
| 7788 | redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7789 | |
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim | 5051d7b | 2008-09-04 01:03:03 +0800 | [diff] [blame] | 7790 | connslots <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7791 | connslots(<backend>) <integer> |
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim | 5051d7b | 2008-09-04 01:03:03 +0800 | [diff] [blame] | 7792 | The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots" |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7793 | still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended |
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim | 5051d7b | 2008-09-04 01:03:03 +0800 | [diff] [blame] | 7794 | usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend. |
| 7795 | |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7796 | 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of |
| 7797 | available server queue slots. |
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim | 5051d7b | 2008-09-04 01:03:03 +0800 | [diff] [blame] | 7798 | |
Willy Tarreau | a36af91 | 2009-10-10 12:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7799 | Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7800 | useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into |
| 7801 | multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and |
| 7802 | you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their |
| 7803 | available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are |
| 7804 | actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of |
Willy Tarreau | a36af91 | 2009-10-10 12:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7805 | available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue". |
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim | 5051d7b | 2008-09-04 01:03:03 +0800 | [diff] [blame] | 7806 | |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7807 | OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care |
| 7808 | of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0, |
| 7809 | then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned |
| 7810 | will be -1. |
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim | 5051d7b | 2008-09-04 01:03:03 +0800 | [diff] [blame] | 7811 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7812 | dst <ip_address> |
Willy Tarreau | ceb4ac9 | 2012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7813 | Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be |
| 7814 | used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses. |
Willy Tarreau | a36af91 | 2009-10-10 12:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7815 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7816 | dst_conn <integer> |
| 7817 | Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket |
| 7818 | including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry |
| 7819 | page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests |
| 7820 | when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign |
| 7821 | different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the |
| 7822 | "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria. |
| 7823 | |
| 7824 | dst_port <integer> |
| 7825 | Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch |
| 7826 | to a different backend for some alternative ports. |
| 7827 | |
| 7828 | fe_conn <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7829 | fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7830 | Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend, |
| 7831 | possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is |
| 7832 | specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another |
| 7833 | frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking, |
| 7834 | or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is |
| 7835 | considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate" |
| 7836 | criteria. |
| 7837 | |
| 7838 | fe_id <integer> |
Cyril Bonté | 78caf84 | 2010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7839 | Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7840 | frontend it was called. |
Willy Tarreau | a36af91 | 2009-10-10 12:02:45 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7841 | |
Willy Tarreau | 079ff0a | 2009-03-05 21:34:28 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7842 | fe_sess_rate <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7843 | fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | 079ff0a | 2009-03-05 21:34:28 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7844 | Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named |
| 7845 | frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions |
| 7846 | per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in |
| 7847 | order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be |
| 7848 | combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for |
| 7849 | the rate to go down below the limit. |
| 7850 | |
| 7851 | Example : |
| 7852 | # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100 |
| 7853 | # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and |
| 7854 | # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to |
| 7855 | # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second. |
| 7856 | frontend mail |
| 7857 | bind :25 |
| 7858 | mode tcp |
| 7859 | maxconn 100 |
| 7860 | acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10 |
| 7861 | tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms |
| 7862 | tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast |
| 7863 | tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7864 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7865 | nbsrv <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7866 | nbsrv(<backend>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7867 | Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend |
| 7868 | or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to |
| 7869 | switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to |
| 7870 | to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with |
| 7871 | "monitor fail". |
Willy Tarreau | 079ff0a | 2009-03-05 21:34:28 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7872 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7873 | queue <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7874 | queue(<backend>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 7875 | Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend, |
| 7876 | including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is |
| 7877 | specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another |
| 7878 | one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, |
| 7879 | generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. |
| 7880 | One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. |
| 7881 | See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria. |
| 7882 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7883 | sc1_bytes_in_rate |
| 7884 | sc2_bytes_in_rate |
| 7885 | Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked |
| 7886 | counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the |
| 7887 | table. See also src_bytes_in_rate. |
| 7888 | |
| 7889 | sc1_bytes_out_rate |
| 7890 | sc2_bytes_out_rate |
| 7891 | Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked |
| 7892 | counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the |
| 7893 | table. See also src_bytes_out_rate. |
| 7894 | |
Willy Tarreau | f73cd11 | 2011-08-13 01:45:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7895 | sc1_clr_gpc0 |
| 7896 | sc2_clr_gpc0 |
| 7897 | Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked |
| 7898 | counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the |
| 7899 | stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test |
| 7900 | can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a |
| 7901 | second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL |
| 7902 | was verified : |
| 7903 | |
| 7904 | # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess |
| 7905 | # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down. |
| 7906 | acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10 |
| 7907 | acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5 |
| 7908 | acl save sc1_clr_gpc0 |
| 7909 | tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save |
| 7910 | tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill |
| 7911 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7912 | sc1_conn_cnt |
| 7913 | sc2_conn_cnt |
| 7914 | Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked |
| 7915 | counters. See also src_conn_cnt. |
| 7916 | |
| 7917 | sc1_conn_cur |
| 7918 | sc2_conn_cur |
| 7919 | Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same |
| 7920 | tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking |
| 7921 | begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur. |
| 7922 | |
| 7923 | sc1_conn_rate |
| 7924 | sc2_conn_rate |
| 7925 | Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters, |
| 7926 | measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. |
| 7927 | See also src_conn_rate. |
| 7928 | |
| 7929 | sc1_get_gpc0 |
| 7930 | sc2_get_gpc0 |
| 7931 | Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the |
| 7932 | currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. |
| 7933 | |
| 7934 | sc1_http_err_cnt |
| 7935 | sc2_http_err_cnt |
| 7936 | Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked |
| 7937 | counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. |
| 7938 | See also src_http_err_cnt. |
| 7939 | |
| 7940 | sc1_http_err_rate |
| 7941 | sc2_http_err_rate |
| 7942 | Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters, |
| 7943 | measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This |
| 7944 | includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also |
| 7945 | src_http_err_rate. |
| 7946 | |
| 7947 | sc1_http_req_cnt |
| 7948 | sc2_http_req_cnt |
| 7949 | Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked |
| 7950 | counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also |
| 7951 | src_http_req_cnt. |
| 7952 | |
| 7953 | sc1_http_req_rate |
| 7954 | sc2_http_req_rate |
| 7955 | Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked |
| 7956 | counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in |
| 7957 | the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also |
| 7958 | src_http_req_rate. |
| 7959 | |
| 7960 | sc1_inc_gpc0 |
| 7961 | sc2_inc_gpc0 |
| 7962 | Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently |
| 7963 | tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the |
| 7964 | stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will |
| 7965 | return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is |
| 7966 | typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection |
| 7967 | when a first ACL was verified : |
| 7968 | |
| 7969 | acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10 |
| 7970 | acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 |
| 7971 | tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill |
| 7972 | |
| 7973 | sc1_kbytes_in |
| 7974 | sc2_kbytes_in |
| 7975 | Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked |
| 7976 | counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The |
| 7977 | test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4 |
| 7978 | terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in. |
| 7979 | |
| 7980 | sc1_kbytes_out |
| 7981 | sc2_kbytes_out |
| 7982 | Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked |
| 7983 | counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The |
| 7984 | test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4 |
| 7985 | terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out. |
| 7986 | |
| 7987 | sc1_sess_cnt |
| 7988 | sc2_sess_cnt |
| 7989 | Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed |
| 7990 | into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request |
| 7991 | connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count |
| 7992 | more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many |
Jamie Gloudon | aaa2100 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 7993 | backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 7994 | with the client. See also src_sess_cnt. |
| 7995 | |
| 7996 | sc1_sess_rate |
| 7997 | sc2_sess_rate |
| 7998 | Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters, |
| 7999 | measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A |
| 8000 | session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection" |
| 8001 | rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each |
| 8002 | connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is |
Jamie Gloudon | aaa2100 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 8003 | performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate. |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8004 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8005 | so_id <integer> |
| 8006 | Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords. |
| 8007 | |
| 8008 | src <ip_address> |
Willy Tarreau | ceb4ac9 | 2012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8009 | Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit |
| 8010 | access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level |
| 8011 | source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy. |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8012 | |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8013 | src_bytes_in_rate <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8014 | src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8015 | Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in |
| 8016 | the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in |
| 8017 | amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8018 | not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8019 | |
| 8020 | src_bytes_out_rate <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8021 | src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8022 | Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the |
| 8023 | current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in |
| 8024 | amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8025 | not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8026 | |
Willy Tarreau | f73cd11 | 2011-08-13 01:45:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8027 | src_clr_gpc0 <integer> |
| 8028 | src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer> |
| 8029 | Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's |
| 8030 | source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated |
| 8031 | stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an |
| 8032 | entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and |
| 8033 | always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression |
| 8034 | in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified : |
| 8035 | |
| 8036 | # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess |
| 8037 | # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down. |
| 8038 | acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10 |
| 8039 | acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5 |
| 8040 | acl save src_clr_gpc0 |
| 8041 | tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save |
| 8042 | tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill |
| 8043 | |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8044 | src_conn_cnt <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8045 | src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8046 | Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current |
| 8047 | connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in |
| 8048 | the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned. |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8049 | See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8050 | |
| 8051 | src_conn_cur <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8052 | src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8053 | Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the |
| 8054 | current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table |
| 8055 | or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8056 | returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8057 | |
| 8058 | src_conn_rate <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8059 | src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8060 | Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address |
| 8061 | in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured |
| 8062 | in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8063 | address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8064 | |
| 8065 | src_get_gpc0 <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8066 | src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8067 | Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the |
| 8068 | connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in |
| 8069 | the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned. |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8070 | See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8071 | |
| 8072 | src_http_err_cnt <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8073 | src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8074 | Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's |
| 8075 | source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated |
| 8076 | stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8077 | If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8078 | |
| 8079 | src_http_err_rate <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8080 | src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8081 | Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source |
| 8082 | IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick- |
| 8083 | table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. |
| 8084 | This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8085 | is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8086 | |
| 8087 | src_http_req_cnt <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8088 | src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8089 | Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's |
| 8090 | source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated |
| 8091 | stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8092 | address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8093 | |
| 8094 | src_http_req_rate <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8095 | src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8096 | Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's |
| 8097 | source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated |
| 8098 | stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the |
| 8099 | table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8100 | not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8101 | |
| 8102 | src_inc_gpc0 <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8103 | src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8104 | Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's |
| 8105 | source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated |
| 8106 | stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is |
| 8107 | created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns |
| 8108 | true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to |
| 8109 | mark a connection when a first ACL was verified : |
| 8110 | |
| 8111 | acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10 |
| 8112 | acl kill src_inc_gpc0 |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8113 | tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8114 | |
| 8115 | src_kbytes_in <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8116 | src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8117 | Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address |
| 8118 | in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured |
| 8119 | in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not |
| 8120 | found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8121 | which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8122 | |
| 8123 | src_kbytes_out <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8124 | src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8125 | Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in |
| 8126 | the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured |
| 8127 | in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not |
| 8128 | found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8129 | which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out. |
Willy Tarreau | a975b8f | 2010-06-05 19:13:27 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8130 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8131 | src_port <integer> |
| 8132 | Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage. |
Willy Tarreau | 079ff0a | 2009-03-05 21:34:28 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8133 | |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8134 | src_sess_cnt <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8135 | src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8136 | Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current |
| 8137 | connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the |
| 8138 | designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that |
| 8139 | they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8140 | is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8141 | |
| 8142 | src_sess_rate <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8143 | src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8144 | Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in |
| 8145 | the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in |
| 8146 | amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a |
| 8147 | connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8148 | found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8149 | |
| 8150 | src_updt_conn_cnt <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8151 | src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | a975b8f | 2010-06-05 19:13:27 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8152 | Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8153 | current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table |
| 8154 | must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match |
Willy Tarreau | a975b8f | 2010-06-05 19:13:27 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8155 | will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration |
| 8156 | timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return |
| 8157 | zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address. |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8158 | Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead. |
Willy Tarreau | a975b8f | 2010-06-05 19:13:27 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8159 | |
| 8160 | Example : |
| 8161 | # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for |
| 8162 | # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second |
| 8163 | # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked. |
| 8164 | listen ssh |
| 8165 | bind :22 |
| 8166 | mode tcp |
| 8167 | maxconn 100 |
Willy Tarreau | c9705a1 | 2010-07-27 20:05:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8168 | stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt |
Willy Tarreau | a975b8f | 2010-06-05 19:13:27 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8169 | tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 } |
| 8170 | server local 127.0.0.1:22 |
| 8171 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8172 | srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | daa824e | 2011-08-05 12:09:44 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8173 | Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server, |
| 8174 | possibly including the connection being evaluated. |
| 8175 | It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full. |
| 8176 | See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria. |
| 8177 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | 35ed801 | 2010-12-15 14:04:51 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8178 | srv_id <integer> |
| 8179 | Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends. |
| 8180 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0b1cd94 | 2010-05-16 22:18:27 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8181 | srv_is_up(<server>) |
| 8182 | srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>) |
| 8183 | Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either |
| 8184 | DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is |
| 8185 | looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it |
| 8186 | is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external |
| 8187 | status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability). |
| 8188 | Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers |
| 8189 | as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that |
| 8190 | rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime. |
| 8191 | |
Willy Tarreau | c735a07 | 2011-03-29 00:57:02 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8192 | table_avl <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8193 | table_avl(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c735a07 | 2011-03-29 00:57:02 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8194 | Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's |
| 8195 | stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt. |
| 8196 | |
| 8197 | table_cnt <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8198 | table_cnt(<table>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | c735a07 | 2011-03-29 00:57:02 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8199 | Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's |
| 8200 | stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and |
| 8201 | table_avl for other entry counting methods. |
| 8202 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8203 | |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8204 | 7.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6) |
| 8205 | --------------------------------------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8206 | |
| 8207 | A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change |
| 8208 | during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance |
Willy Tarreau | e965652 | 2010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8209 | through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content" |
| 8210 | keyword for more detailed information on the subject. |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8211 | |
Emeric Brun | b435408 | 2012-09-28 17:28:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8212 | client_crt |
| 8213 | Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over |
Willy Tarreau | f7bc57c | 2012-10-03 00:19:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8214 | SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'. |
Emeric Brun | b435408 | 2012-09-28 17:28:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8215 | |
Willy Tarreau | 7875d09 | 2012-09-10 08:20:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8216 | is_ssl |
Willy Tarreau | f7bc57c | 2012-10-03 00:19:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8217 | Returns true when the incoming connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport |
| 8218 | layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared |
| 8219 | with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option. |
Willy Tarreau | 7875d09 | 2012-09-10 08:20:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8220 | |
Willy Tarreau | b6672b5 | 2011-12-12 17:23:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8221 | rep_ssl_hello_type <integer> |
| 8222 | Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3 |
| 8223 | or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>. |
| 8224 | This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a |
Willy Tarreau | 7875d09 | 2012-09-10 08:20:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8225 | SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents |
| 8226 | found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data |
| 8227 | layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. |
Willy Tarreau | b6672b5 | 2011-12-12 17:23:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8228 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8229 | req_len <integer> |
Emeric Brun | bede3d0 | 2009-06-30 17:54:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8230 | Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8231 | specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not |
| 8232 | return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with |
| 8233 | equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the |
| 8234 | session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and |
| 8235 | return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in. |
| 8236 | This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. |
| 8237 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2492d5b | 2009-07-11 00:06:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8238 | req_proto_http |
| 8239 | Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly |
| 8240 | parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8241 | is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance |
Willy Tarreau | 2492d5b | 2009-07-11 00:06:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8242 | to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one |
| 8243 | using TCP request content inspection rules. |
| 8244 | |
Emeric Brun | bede3d0 | 2009-06-30 17:54:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8245 | req_rdp_cookie <string> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8246 | req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string> |
Emeric Brun | bede3d0 | 2009-06-30 17:54:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8247 | Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and |
| 8248 | a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is |
| 8249 | checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The |
| 8250 | parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol |
| 8251 | specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful |
| 8252 | with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client |
| 8253 | connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be |
| 8254 | used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users. |
| 8255 | |
| 8256 | req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8257 | req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer> |
Emeric Brun | bede3d0 | 2009-06-30 17:54:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8258 | Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol |
| 8259 | and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or |
| 8260 | one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way |
| 8261 | of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH |
| 8262 | cookies. |
| 8263 | |
Willy Tarreau | b6672b5 | 2011-12-12 17:23:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8264 | req_ssl_hello_type <integer> |
| 8265 | Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3 |
| 8266 | or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>. |
| 8267 | This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an |
Willy Tarreau | 7875d09 | 2012-09-10 08:20:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8268 | SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents |
| 8269 | found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data |
| 8270 | layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. |
Willy Tarreau | b6672b5 | 2011-12-12 17:23:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8271 | |
| 8272 | req_ssl_sni <string> |
| 8273 | Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3 |
| 8274 | or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension |
| 8275 | (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the |
| 8276 | client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing |
| 8277 | or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This |
| 8278 | test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content |
| 8279 | switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client |
Willy Tarreau | 7875d09 | 2012-09-10 08:20:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8280 | hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw |
| 8281 | contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an |
Willy Tarreau | f7bc57c | 2012-10-03 00:19:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8282 | SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" |
Willy Tarreau | 7875d09 | 2012-09-10 08:20:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8283 | option. See also "ssl_sni" below. |
Willy Tarreau | b6672b5 | 2011-12-12 17:23:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8284 | |
| 8285 | Examples : |
| 8286 | # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds |
| 8287 | tcp-request inspect-delay 5s |
| 8288 | tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 } |
| 8289 | use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites } |
| 8290 | default_backend bk_sorry_page |
| 8291 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8292 | req_ssl_ver <decimal> |
| 8293 | Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol |
| 8294 | version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3 |
| 8295 | messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being |
| 8296 | easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the |
| 8297 | message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note |
| 8298 | that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used |
Willy Tarreau | 7875d09 | 2012-09-10 08:20:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8299 | with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw |
| 8300 | contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an |
Willy Tarreau | f7bc57c | 2012-10-03 00:19:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8301 | SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" |
Willy Tarreau | 7875d09 | 2012-09-10 08:20:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8302 | option. |
| 8303 | |
Willy Tarreau | 7875d09 | 2012-09-10 08:20:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8304 | ssl_has_sni |
| 8305 | This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension |
Willy Tarreau | f7bc57c | 2012-10-03 00:19:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8306 | in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns |
| 8307 | true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires |
| 8308 | that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check |
| 8309 | haproxy -vv). |
Willy Tarreau | 7875d09 | 2012-09-10 08:20:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8310 | |
| 8311 | ssl_sni <string> |
Willy Tarreau | f7bc57c | 2012-10-03 00:19:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8312 | Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport |
| 8313 | layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension |
| 8314 | sent by the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field |
| 8315 | (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different |
Cyril Bonté | 9c1eb1e | 2012-10-09 22:45:34 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8316 | from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being |
| 8317 | deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. |
| 8318 | See also "ssl_sni_end" and "ssl_sni_req" below. This requires that the SSL |
| 8319 | library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). |
Willy Tarreau | 7875d09 | 2012-09-10 08:20:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8320 | |
| 8321 | ssl_sni_end <string> |
Willy Tarreau | f7bc57c | 2012-10-03 00:19:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8322 | Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport |
| 8323 | layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension |
| 8324 | sent by the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field |
| 8325 | (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different |
Cyril Bonté | 9c1eb1e | 2012-10-09 22:45:34 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8326 | from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being |
| 8327 | deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This |
| 8328 | requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions |
| 8329 | enabled (check haproxy -vv). |
Willy Tarreau | 7875d09 | 2012-09-10 08:20:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8330 | |
| 8331 | ssl_sni_req <regex> |
Willy Tarreau | f7bc57c | 2012-10-03 00:19:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8332 | Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport |
| 8333 | layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension |
| 8334 | sent by the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field |
| 8335 | (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different |
Cyril Bonté | 9c1eb1e | 2012-10-09 22:45:34 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8336 | from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being |
| 8337 | deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This |
| 8338 | requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions |
| 8339 | enabled (check haproxy -vv). |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8340 | |
Emeric Brun | 3603fbe | 2012-09-28 18:35:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8341 | ssl_verify_caerr <errorID> |
Willy Tarreau | f7bc57c | 2012-10-03 00:19:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8342 | Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport |
| 8343 | layer and the ID of the first error detected during verify at depth > 0 match |
| 8344 | the errorID. |
Emeric Brun | 3603fbe | 2012-09-28 18:35:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8345 | |
| 8346 | ssl_verify_caerr_depth <depth> |
Willy Tarreau | f7bc57c | 2012-10-03 00:19:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8347 | Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport |
| 8348 | layer and the depth of the first error detected during verify match the |
| 8349 | depth. |
Emeric Brun | 3603fbe | 2012-09-28 18:35:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8350 | |
| 8351 | ssl_verify_crterr <errorID> |
Willy Tarreau | f7bc57c | 2012-10-03 00:19:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8352 | Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport |
| 8353 | layer and the ID of the first error detected during verify at depth == 0 |
| 8354 | match the errorID. |
Emeric Brun | 3603fbe | 2012-09-28 18:35:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8355 | |
Emeric Brun | c68af8d | 2012-09-28 18:14:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8356 | ssl_verify_result <errorID> |
Willy Tarreau | f7bc57c | 2012-10-03 00:19:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8357 | Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport |
| 8358 | layer and the verify result match the errorID. |
Emeric Brun | c68af8d | 2012-09-28 18:14:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8359 | |
Willy Tarreau | b6fb420 | 2008-07-20 11:18:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8360 | wait_end |
| 8361 | Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in |
| 8362 | conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early. |
| 8363 | It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some |
| 8364 | special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately |
| 8365 | returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule. |
| 8366 | Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior |
| 8367 | declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content |
| 8368 | inspection. |
| 8369 | |
| 8370 | Examples : |
| 8371 | # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds |
| 8372 | tcp-request inspect-delay 2s |
| 8373 | tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END |
| 8374 | |
| 8375 | # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected |
| 8376 | tcp-request inspect-delay 10s |
| 8377 | acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24 |
| 8378 | acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24 |
| 8379 | tcp-request content accept if goodguys |
| 8380 | tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END |
| 8381 | tcp-request content reject |
| 8382 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8383 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8384 | 7.5.3. Matching at Layer 7 |
| 8385 | -------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8386 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6264477 | 2008-07-16 18:36:06 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8387 | A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8388 | application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been |
| 8389 | read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources |
| 8390 | than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed. |
| 8391 | |
Willy Tarreau | a7ad50c | 2012-04-29 15:39:40 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8392 | base <string> |
| 8393 | Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path |
| 8394 | part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the |
| 8395 | question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known |
| 8396 | files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico". |
| 8397 | See also "path" and "uri". |
| 8398 | |
| 8399 | base_beg <string> |
| 8400 | Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This |
| 8401 | can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also |
| 8402 | "path_beg". |
| 8403 | |
| 8404 | base_dir <string> |
| 8405 | Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with |
| 8406 | slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and |
| 8407 | "path_dir" instead. |
| 8408 | |
| 8409 | base_dom <string> |
| 8410 | Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots |
| 8411 | in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom" |
| 8412 | instead. |
| 8413 | |
| 8414 | base_end <string> |
| 8415 | Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may |
| 8416 | be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper. |
| 8417 | |
| 8418 | base_len <integer> |
| 8419 | Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges |
| 8420 | specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance. |
| 8421 | |
| 8422 | base_reg <regex> |
| 8423 | Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular |
| 8424 | expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that |
| 8425 | regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg" |
| 8426 | and all "base_" criteria. |
| 8427 | |
| 8428 | base_sub <string> |
| 8429 | Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be |
| 8430 | used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See |
| 8431 | also "base_dir". |
| 8432 | |
Willy Tarreau | 04aa6a9 | 2012-04-06 18:57:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8433 | cook(<name>) <string> |
| 8434 | All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie |
| 8435 | with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are |
| 8436 | found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and |
| 8437 | the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The |
| 8438 | cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies |
| 8439 | sent by the server. |
| 8440 | |
| 8441 | The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match |
| 8442 | any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance, |
| 8443 | checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" : |
| 8444 | |
| 8445 | cook(profile) silver gold |
| 8446 | |
| 8447 | cook_beg(<name>) <string> |
| 8448 | Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the |
| 8449 | strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the |
| 8450 | scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server. |
| 8451 | |
| 8452 | cook_cnt(<name>) <integer> |
| 8453 | Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches |
| 8454 | the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or |
| 8455 | abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header |
| 8456 | matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the |
| 8457 | server. |
| 8458 | |
| 8459 | cook_dir(<name>) <string> |
| 8460 | Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings |
| 8461 | either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or |
| 8462 | directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies. |
| 8463 | See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir() |
| 8464 | variant for response cookies sent by the server. |
| 8465 | |
| 8466 | cook_dom(<name>) <string> |
| 8467 | Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings |
| 8468 | either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name |
| 8469 | matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the |
| 8470 | scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server. |
| 8471 | |
| 8472 | cook_end(<name>) <string> |
| 8473 | Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the |
| 8474 | strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the |
| 8475 | scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server. |
| 8476 | |
| 8477 | cook_len(<name>) <integer> |
| 8478 | Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches |
| 8479 | the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large |
| 8480 | cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test. |
| 8481 | See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len() |
| 8482 | variant for response cookies sent by the server. |
| 8483 | |
| 8484 | cook_reg(<name>) <regex> |
| 8485 | Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular |
| 8486 | expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that |
| 8487 | regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria, |
| 8488 | as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the |
| 8489 | scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server. |
| 8490 | |
| 8491 | cook_sub(<name>) <string> |
| 8492 | Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of |
| 8493 | the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the |
| 8494 | scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server. |
| 8495 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5153936 | 2012-05-08 12:46:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8496 | cook_val(<name>) <integer> |
| 8497 | Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which |
| 8498 | matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server |
| 8499 | based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not |
| 8500 | match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the |
| 8501 | scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server. |
| 8502 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8503 | hdr <string> |
Willy Tarreau | 185b5c4 | 2012-04-26 15:11:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8504 | hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8505 | Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a |
| 8506 | particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any |
| 8507 | space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies |
| 8508 | with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas. |
Willy Tarreau | 185b5c4 | 2012-04-26 15:11:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8509 | If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only |
| 8510 | this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from |
| 8511 | the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate |
| 8512 | positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr() |
| 8513 | variant for response headers sent by the server. |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8514 | |
| 8515 | The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria |
Willy Tarreau | 25c1ebc | 2012-04-25 16:21:44 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8516 | match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8517 | instance, checking that "connection: close" is set : |
| 8518 | |
| 8519 | hdr(Connection) -i close |
| 8520 | |
| 8521 | hdr_beg <string> |
Willy Tarreau | 185b5c4 | 2012-04-26 15:11:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8522 | hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8523 | Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See |
| 8524 | "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for |
| 8525 | response headers sent by the server. |
| 8526 | |
| 8527 | hdr_cnt <integer> |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8528 | hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8529 | Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches |
| 8530 | the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header |
| 8531 | line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to |
| 8532 | detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block |
| 8533 | request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one |
| 8534 | of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use |
| 8535 | the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server. |
| 8536 | |
| 8537 | hdr_dir <string> |
Willy Tarreau | 185b5c4 | 2012-04-26 15:11:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8538 | hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8539 | Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either |
| 8540 | isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or |
| 8541 | directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more |
| 8542 | information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response |
| 8543 | headers sent by the server. |
| 8544 | |
| 8545 | hdr_dom <string> |
Willy Tarreau | 185b5c4 | 2012-04-26 15:11:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8546 | hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8547 | Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either |
| 8548 | isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching, |
| 8549 | and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on |
| 8550 | header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the |
| 8551 | server. |
| 8552 | |
| 8553 | hdr_end <string> |
Willy Tarreau | 185b5c4 | 2012-04-26 15:11:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8554 | hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8555 | Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr" |
| 8556 | for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for |
| 8557 | response headers sent by the server. |
| 8558 | |
| 8559 | hdr_ip <ip_address> |
Willy Tarreau | ceb4ac9 | 2012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8560 | hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address> |
| 8561 | Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address |
| 8562 | matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For |
| 8563 | or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8564 | shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server. |
| 8565 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0e69854 | 2011-09-16 08:32:32 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8566 | hdr_len <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | 185b5c4 | 2012-04-26 15:11:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8567 | hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | 0e69854 | 2011-09-16 08:32:32 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8568 | Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the |
| 8569 | values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large |
| 8570 | headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the |
| 8571 | shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server. |
| 8572 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8573 | hdr_reg <regex> |
Willy Tarreau | 185b5c4 | 2012-04-26 15:11:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8574 | hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex> |
Willy Tarreau | 04aa6a9 | 2012-04-06 18:57:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8575 | Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8576 | can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching |
| 8577 | is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as |
| 8578 | "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for |
| 8579 | response headers sent by the server. |
| 8580 | |
| 8581 | hdr_sub <string> |
Willy Tarreau | 185b5c4 | 2012-04-26 15:11:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8582 | hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8583 | Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr" |
| 8584 | for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for |
| 8585 | response headers sent by the server. |
| 8586 | |
| 8587 | hdr_val <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | 185b5c4 | 2012-04-26 15:11:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8588 | hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8589 | Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the |
| 8590 | values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to |
| 8591 | acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header |
| 8592 | matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server. |
| 8593 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8594 | http_auth(<userlist>) |
| 8595 | http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]* |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8596 | Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches |
| 8597 | username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to |
| 8598 | use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one |
| 8599 | of specified groups. |
| 8600 | |
| 8601 | Currently only http basic auth is supported. |
| 8602 | |
Willy Tarreau | 85c27da | 2011-09-16 07:53:52 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8603 | http_first_req |
Willy Tarreau | 7f18e52 | 2010-10-22 20:04:13 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8604 | Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the |
| 8605 | connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing |
| 8606 | from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform |
| 8607 | some specific ACL checks only on the first request. |
| 8608 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8609 | method <string> |
| 8610 | Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL |
| 8611 | already check for most common methods. |
| 8612 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8613 | path <string> |
| 8614 | Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first |
| 8615 | slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be |
| 8616 | used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico. |
| 8617 | |
| 8618 | path_beg <string> |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8619 | Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used |
| 8620 | to send certain directory names to alternative backends. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8621 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8622 | path_dir <string> |
| 8623 | Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with |
| 8624 | slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name |
| 8625 | matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also |
| 8626 | "url_dir" and "path_sub". |
| 8627 | |
| 8628 | path_dom <string> |
| 8629 | Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots |
| 8630 | in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy |
| 8631 | requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom". |
| 8632 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8633 | path_end <string> |
| 8634 | Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to |
| 8635 | control file name extension. |
| 8636 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0e69854 | 2011-09-16 08:32:32 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8637 | path_len <integer> |
| 8638 | Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified. |
| 8639 | This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance. |
| 8640 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8641 | path_reg <regex> |
| 8642 | Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be |
| 8643 | used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower |
| 8644 | than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria. |
| 8645 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8646 | path_sub <string> |
| 8647 | Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to |
| 8648 | detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also |
| 8649 | "path_dir". |
| 8650 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ce3aa0 | 2012-04-25 18:46:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8651 | payload(<offset>,<length>) <string> |
| 8652 | Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the |
| 8653 | request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the |
| 8654 | strings. |
| 8655 | |
| 8656 | payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) |
| 8657 | Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length> |
| 8658 | bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in |
| 8659 | the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of |
| 8660 | the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if |
| 8661 | prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. |
| 8662 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8663 | req_ver <string> |
| 8664 | Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined |
| 8665 | ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1. |
| 8666 | |
| 8667 | status <integer> |
| 8668 | Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be |
| 8669 | used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove |
| 8670 | any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. |
| 8671 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8672 | url <string> |
| 8673 | Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match |
Willy Tarreau | a7ad50c | 2012-04-29 15:39:40 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8674 | "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base". |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8675 | |
| 8676 | url_beg <string> |
| 8677 | Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to |
Willy Tarreau | a7ad50c | 2012-04-29 15:39:40 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8678 | check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also |
| 8679 | "base_beg". |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8680 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8681 | url_dir <string> |
| 8682 | Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with |
| 8683 | slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name |
| 8684 | matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also |
| 8685 | "path_dir" and "url_sub". |
| 8686 | |
| 8687 | url_dom <string> |
| 8688 | Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots |
| 8689 | in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of |
| 8690 | wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub". |
| 8691 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8692 | url_end <string> |
| 8693 | Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited |
| 8694 | use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching. |
Willy Tarreau | 6a06a40 | 2007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8695 | |
Willy Tarreau | ceb4ac9 | 2012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8696 | url_ip <address> |
| 8697 | Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP |
| 8698 | request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local |
| 8699 | network. It is useful with option "http_proxy". |
Alexandre Cassen | 5eb1a90 | 2007-11-29 15:43:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8700 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0e69854 | 2011-09-16 08:32:32 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8701 | url_len <integer> |
| 8702 | Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This |
| 8703 | may be used to detect abusive requests for instance. |
| 8704 | |
Alexandre Cassen | 5eb1a90 | 2007-11-29 15:43:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8705 | url_port <integer> |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8706 | Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can |
| 8707 | be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option |
Willy Tarreau | 198a744 | 2008-01-17 12:05:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8708 | "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80 |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8709 | is assumed. |
Alexandre Cassen | 5eb1a90 | 2007-11-29 15:43:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8710 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8711 | url_reg <regex> |
| 8712 | Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be |
| 8713 | used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower |
Willy Tarreau | a7ad50c | 2012-04-29 15:39:40 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8714 | than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria. |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8715 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8716 | url_sub <string> |
| 8717 | Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to |
| 8718 | detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub". |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 6b35ce1 | 2010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8719 | |
Willy Tarreau | 25c1ebc | 2012-04-25 16:21:44 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8720 | urlp(<name>) <string> |
| 8721 | Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the |
| 8722 | parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive. |
| 8723 | |
| 8724 | The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter |
| 8725 | matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. |
| 8726 | |
| 8727 | urlp_beg(<name>) <string> |
| 8728 | Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings. |
| 8729 | This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a |
| 8730 | protocol scheme. |
| 8731 | |
| 8732 | urlp_dir(<name>) <string> |
| 8733 | Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings |
| 8734 | either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename |
| 8735 | or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of |
| 8736 | wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub". |
| 8737 | |
| 8738 | urlp_dom(<name>) <string> |
| 8739 | Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots |
| 8740 | in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching |
| 8741 | in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding |
| 8742 | prefixes. See also "urlp_sub". |
| 8743 | |
| 8744 | urlp_end(<name>) <string> |
| 8745 | Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings. |
| 8746 | |
| 8747 | urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address> |
Willy Tarreau | ceb4ac9 | 2012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8748 | Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address |
| 8749 | which matches one of the specified addresses. |
Willy Tarreau | 25c1ebc | 2012-04-25 16:21:44 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8750 | |
| 8751 | urlp_len(<name>) <integer> |
| 8752 | Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values |
| 8753 | or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance. |
| 8754 | |
| 8755 | urlp_reg(<name>) <regex> |
| 8756 | Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular |
| 8757 | expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that |
| 8758 | regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all |
| 8759 | "urlp_" criteria. |
| 8760 | |
| 8761 | urlp_sub(<name>) <string> |
| 8762 | Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It |
| 8763 | can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See |
| 8764 | also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria. |
| 8765 | |
Willy Tarreau | a9fddca | 2012-07-31 07:51:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8766 | urlp_val(<name>) <integer> |
| 8767 | Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching |
| 8768 | the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does |
| 8769 | not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match |
| 8770 | negative data. |
| 8771 | |
Willy Tarreau | 198a744 | 2008-01-17 12:05:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8772 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8773 | 7.6. Pre-defined ACLs |
| 8774 | --------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8775 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8776 | Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in |
| 8777 | every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in |
Patrick Mézard | 2382ad6 | 2010-05-09 10:43:32 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8778 | order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below. |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8779 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8780 | ACL name Equivalent to Usage |
| 8781 | ---------------+-----------------------------+--------------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8782 | FALSE always_false never match |
Willy Tarreau | 2492d5b | 2009-07-11 00:06:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8783 | HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8784 | HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0 |
| 8785 | HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1 |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8786 | HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length |
| 8787 | HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme |
| 8788 | HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/" |
| 8789 | HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*" |
| 8790 | LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8791 | METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method |
| 8792 | METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method |
| 8793 | METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method |
| 8794 | METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method |
| 8795 | METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method |
| 8796 | METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method |
Emeric Brun | bede3d0 | 2009-06-30 17:54:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8797 | RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8798 | REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8799 | TRUE always_true always match |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8800 | WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis |
| 8801 | ---------------+-----------------------------+--------------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8802 | |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8803 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8804 | 7.7. Using ACLs to form conditions |
| 8805 | ---------------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8806 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8807 | Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a |
| 8808 | combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported : |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8809 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8810 | - AND (implicit) |
| 8811 | - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator) |
| 8812 | - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!") |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8813 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8814 | A condition is formed as a disjunctive form: |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8815 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8816 | [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ... |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8817 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8818 | Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement, |
| 8819 | indicating when the condition will trigger the action. |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8820 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8821 | For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than |
| 8822 | "OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD |
| 8823 | requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which |
| 8824 | is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS ! |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8825 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8826 | acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 |
| 8827 | block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl |
| 8828 | block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT |
| 8829 | block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8830 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8831 | To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site |
| 8832 | and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts : |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8833 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8834 | acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css |
| 8835 | acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js |
| 8836 | acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www |
| 8837 | acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp. |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8838 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8839 | # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls |
| 8840 | # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest. |
| 8841 | use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static |
| 8842 | use_backend www if host_www |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8843 | |
Willy Tarreau | 95fa469 | 2010-02-01 13:05:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8844 | It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL |
| 8845 | expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must |
| 8846 | be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because |
Jamie Gloudon | 801a0a3 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 8847 | the braces must be seen as independent words). Example : |
Willy Tarreau | 95fa469 | 2010-02-01 13:05:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8848 | |
| 8849 | The following rule : |
| 8850 | |
| 8851 | acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 |
| 8852 | block if METH_POST missing_cl |
| 8853 | |
| 8854 | Can also be written that way : |
| 8855 | |
| 8856 | block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 } |
| 8857 | |
| 8858 | It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier |
| 8859 | to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very |
| 8860 | simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more |
| 8861 | sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of |
| 8862 | good use is the following : |
| 8863 | |
| 8864 | With named ACLs : |
| 8865 | |
| 8866 | acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 |
| 8867 | acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2 |
| 8868 | monitor fail if site_dead |
| 8869 | |
| 8870 | With anonymous ACLs : |
| 8871 | |
| 8872 | monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 } |
| 8873 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8874 | See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords. |
Willy Tarreau | ced2701 | 2008-01-17 20:35:34 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8875 | |
Willy Tarreau | 5764b38 | 2007-11-30 17:46:49 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8876 | |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8877 | 7.8. Pattern extraction |
| 8878 | ----------------------- |
| 8879 | |
| 8880 | The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and |
| 8881 | response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored, |
| 8882 | for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case. |
| 8883 | |
| 8884 | All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as |
| 8885 | "pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It |
| 8886 | begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of |
| 8887 | arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As |
| 8888 | much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their |
| 8889 | equivalent used in ACLs. |
| 8890 | |
| 8891 | The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following : |
| 8892 | |
Willy Tarreau | a7ad50c | 2012-04-29 15:39:40 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8893 | base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the |
| 8894 | path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and |
| 8895 | ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual |
| 8896 | hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve |
| 8897 | shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick |
| 8898 | table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly |
| 8899 | requested objects by host/path. |
Emeric Brun | b435408 | 2012-09-28 17:28:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8900 | client_crt |
| 8901 | Returns 1 if a client certificate is present in an incoming |
Willy Tarreau | f7bc57c | 2012-10-03 00:19:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8902 | connection over SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise 0. |
Willy Tarreau | a7ad50c | 2012-04-29 15:39:40 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8903 | |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8904 | src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. |
David du Colombier | 9a6d3c9 | 2011-03-17 10:40:24 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8905 | It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. |
| 8906 | On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, |
| 8907 | according to RFC 4291. |
| 8908 | |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8909 | dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the |
| 8910 | client side, which is the address the client connected to. |
| 8911 | It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of |
David du Colombier | 9a6d3c9 | 2011-03-17 10:40:24 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8912 | type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. |
| 8913 | On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, |
| 8914 | according to RFC 4291. |
| 8915 | |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8916 | dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client |
| 8917 | side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be |
| 8918 | used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic |
| 8919 | ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of |
| 8920 | type integer and only works with such tables. |
| 8921 | |
Willy Tarreau | 185b5c4 | 2012-04-26 15:11:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8922 | hdr(<name>[,<occ>]) |
| 8923 | This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP |
| 8924 | request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as |
| 8925 | a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the |
| 8926 | first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values |
| 8927 | indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the |
| 8928 | last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once |
Willy Tarreau | e428fb7 | 2011-12-16 21:50:30 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8929 | converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. |
Willy Tarreau | 4a56897 | 2010-05-12 08:08:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8930 | |
Willy Tarreau | f7bc57c | 2012-10-03 00:19:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8931 | is_ssl This checks the transport layer used by incoming connection, and |
| 8932 | returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport |
| 8933 | layer, otherwise zero. |
Willy Tarreau | 7875d09 | 2012-09-10 08:20:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8934 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6812bcf | 2012-04-29 09:28:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8935 | path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A |
| 8936 | typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals |
| 8937 | which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and |
| 8938 | keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be |
| 8939 | wiser to use "url" instead. |
| 8940 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8941 | payload(<offset>,<length>) |
Emeric Brun | 6a1cefa | 2010-09-24 18:15:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8942 | This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting |
| 8943 | at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request |
| 8944 | on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store |
| 8945 | response"). |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 8946 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8947 | payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) |
Emeric Brun | 6a1cefa | 2010-09-24 18:15:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8948 | This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the |
| 8949 | block is read from response or request buffer at <offset> |
| 8950 | bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step |
| 8951 | data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes |
| 8952 | (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>). |
| 8953 | If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to |
| 8954 | <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute. |
| 8955 | Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter. |
Cyril Bonté | 108cf6e | 2012-04-21 23:30:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8956 | |
Willy Tarreau | 25c1ebc | 2012-04-25 16:21:44 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8957 | src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side, |
| 8958 | which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely |
| 8959 | that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost. |
| 8960 | It is of type integer and only works with such tables. |
| 8961 | |
Willy Tarreau | f7bc57c | 2012-10-03 00:19:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8962 | ssl_has_sni This checks the transport layer used by incoming connection, and |
| 8963 | returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport |
| 8964 | layer and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension, |
Willy Tarreau | 7875d09 | 2012-09-10 08:20:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8965 | otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with |
Willy Tarreau | f7bc57c | 2012-10-03 00:19:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8966 | support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). |
Willy Tarreau | 7875d09 | 2012-09-10 08:20:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8967 | |
| 8968 | ssl_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming |
Willy Tarreau | f7bc57c | 2012-10-03 00:19:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8969 | connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally |
| 8970 | deciphered by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching |
| 8971 | the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must |
| 8972 | have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check |
| 8973 | haproxy -vv). |
Willy Tarreau | 7875d09 | 2012-09-10 08:20:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8974 | |
Emeric Brun | 3603fbe | 2012-09-28 18:35:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8975 | ssl_verify_caerr |
| 8976 | Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify at |
| 8977 | depth > 0 or 0 if no errors. |
| 8978 | |
| 8979 | ssl_verify_caerr_depth |
| 8980 | Returns the depth of the first error detected during verify. |
| 8981 | |
| 8982 | ssl_verify_crterr |
| 8983 | Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify at |
| 8984 | depth == 0 or 0 if no errors. |
| 8985 | |
Emeric Brun | c68af8d | 2012-09-28 18:14:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8986 | ssl_verify_result |
| 8987 | Returns the verify result errorID when the incoming connection |
Willy Tarreau | f7bc57c | 2012-10-03 00:19:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8988 | was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. |
Emeric Brun | c68af8d | 2012-09-28 18:14:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8989 | |
Willy Tarreau | 6812bcf | 2012-04-29 09:28:50 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 8990 | url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A |
| 8991 | typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals |
| 8992 | which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and |
| 8993 | keep them in caches. See also "path". |
| 8994 | |
| 8995 | url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the |
| 8996 | host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very |
| 8997 | limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field |
| 8998 | as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a |
| 8999 | given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a |
| 9000 | table for a given source address. |
| 9001 | |
| 9002 | url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably |
| 9003 | is totally useless but it was available at no cost. |
| 9004 | |
bedis | 4c75cca | 2012-10-05 08:38:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9005 | url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9006 | This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in |
bedis | 4c75cca | 2012-10-05 08:38:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9007 | the parameter string of the request and uses the corresponding |
| 9008 | value to match. Optionally, a delimiter can be provided. If not |
| 9009 | then the question mark '?' is used by default. |
| 9010 | A typical use is to get sticky session through url for cases |
| 9011 | where cookies cannot be used. |
| 9012 | |
| 9013 | Example : |
| 9014 | # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id |
| 9015 | stick on url_param(PHPSESSIONID) |
| 9016 | # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id |
| 9017 | stick on url_param(JSESSIONID,;) |
David Cournapeau | 16023ee | 2010-12-23 20:55:41 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 9018 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9019 | rdp_cookie(<name>) |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9020 | This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string |
| 9021 | and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of |
| 9022 | persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically |
| 9023 | done if there is no msts cookie present. |
Simon Horman | ab814e0 | 2011-06-24 14:50:20 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 9024 | |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9025 | This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing |
| 9026 | algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients |
| 9027 | to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP |
| 9028 | cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm |
| 9029 | such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will |
| 9030 | lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend |
| 9031 | servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie". |
Simon Horman | ab814e0 | 2011-06-24 14:50:20 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 9032 | |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9033 | Example : |
| 9034 | listen tse-farm |
| 9035 | bind 0.0.0.0:3389 |
| 9036 | # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request |
| 9037 | tcp-request inspect-delay 5s |
| 9038 | tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE |
| 9039 | # apply RDP cookie persistence |
| 9040 | persist rdp-cookie |
| 9041 | # Persist based on the mstshash cookie |
| 9042 | # This is only useful makes sense if |
| 9043 | # balance rdp-cookie is not used |
| 9044 | stick-table type string size 204800 |
| 9045 | stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash) |
| 9046 | server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389 |
| 9047 | server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389 |
Simon Horman | ab814e0 | 2011-06-24 14:50:20 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 9048 | |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9049 | See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", |
| 9050 | "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL. |
Simon Horman | ab814e0 | 2011-06-24 14:50:20 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 9051 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9052 | cookie(<name>) |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9053 | This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a |
Willy Tarreau | 28376d6 | 2012-04-26 21:26:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9054 | "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header |
| 9055 | from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A |
| 9056 | typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile |
| 9057 | use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession" |
| 9058 | does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for |
| 9059 | multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. |
Willy Tarreau | b3eb221 | 2011-07-01 16:16:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9060 | |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9061 | See also : "appsession" |
Willy Tarreau | b3eb221 | 2011-07-01 16:16:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9062 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9063 | set-cookie(<name>) |
Willy Tarreau | 28376d6 | 2012-04-26 21:26:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9064 | This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the |
| 9065 | "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and |
| 9066 | responses. This keyword will disappear soon. |
| 9067 | |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9068 | This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a |
| 9069 | "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the |
| 9070 | corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what |
| 9071 | "appsession" does with default options, but with support for |
| 9072 | multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. |
Willy Tarreau | b3eb221 | 2011-07-01 16:16:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9073 | |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9074 | See also : "appsession" |
Willy Tarreau | b3eb221 | 2011-07-01 16:16:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9075 | |
Simon Horman | ab814e0 | 2011-06-24 14:50:20 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 9076 | |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9077 | The currently available list of transformations include : |
| 9078 | |
| 9079 | lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed |
| 9080 | after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion |
| 9081 | function returning a string type. The result is of type string. |
| 9082 | |
| 9083 | upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed |
| 9084 | after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion |
| 9085 | function returning a string type. The result is of type string. |
| 9086 | |
Hervé COMMOWICK | a3eb39c | 2011-08-05 18:48:51 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9087 | ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups |
Willy Tarreau | d31d6eb | 2010-01-26 18:01:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9088 | and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a |
| 9089 | certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use |
| 9090 | the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg: |
| 9091 | 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24). |
| 9092 | |
Willy Tarreau | b937b7e | 2010-01-12 15:27:54 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9093 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9094 | 8. Logging |
| 9095 | ---------- |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9096 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9097 | One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably |
| 9098 | provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is |
| 9099 | very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information |
| 9100 | provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session |
| 9101 | state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9102 | to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9103 | headers. |
| 9104 | |
| 9105 | In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency |
| 9106 | about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to |
| 9107 | send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters : |
| 9108 | |
| 9109 | - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..) |
| 9110 | - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...) |
| 9111 | - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections) |
| 9112 | - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or |
| 9113 | at the termination. |
| 9114 | |
| 9115 | The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers |
| 9116 | allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon |
| 9117 | as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors, |
| 9118 | while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in |
| 9119 | real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour |
| 9120 | delay. |
| 9121 | |
| 9122 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9123 | 8.1. Log levels |
| 9124 | --------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9125 | |
Simon Horman | df791f5 | 2011-05-29 15:01:10 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 9126 | TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time, |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9127 | source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times, |
Simon Horman | df791f5 | 2011-05-29 15:01:10 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 9128 | HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions |
| 9129 | in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example |
| 9130 | track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two |
| 9131 | syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information |
| 9132 | about log facilities. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9133 | |
| 9134 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9135 | 8.2. Log formats |
| 9136 | ---------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9137 | |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9138 | HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats |
Simon Horman | df791f5 | 2011-05-29 15:01:10 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 9139 | and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary |
| 9140 | slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain |
| 9141 | options. The supported formats are as follows : |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9142 | |
| 9143 | - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only |
| 9144 | provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment |
| 9145 | it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name. |
| 9146 | This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great |
| 9147 | extents. |
| 9148 | |
| 9149 | - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option |
| 9150 | tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the |
| 9151 | connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer |
| 9152 | information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This |
| 9153 | format is recommended for pure TCP proxies. |
| 9154 | |
| 9155 | - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format |
| 9156 | is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the |
| 9157 | same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as |
| 9158 | the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This |
| 9159 | format is recommended for HTTP proxies. |
| 9160 | |
Emeric Brun | 3a058f3 | 2009-06-30 18:26:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9161 | - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the |
| 9162 | fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all |
| 9163 | timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the |
| 9164 | common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format. |
| 9165 | |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9166 | - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line. |
| 9167 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9168 | Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format |
| 9169 | specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a |
| 9170 | field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog |
| 9171 | servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is |
| 9172 | always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and |
| 9173 | identifier. |
| 9174 | |
| 9175 | Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below |
| 9176 | might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be |
| 9177 | prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is |
| 9178 | broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a |
| 9179 | backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters. |
| 9180 | |
| 9181 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9182 | 8.2.1. Default log format |
| 9183 | ------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9184 | |
| 9185 | This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon |
| 9186 | as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only |
| 9187 | format which logs the request's destination IP and ports. |
| 9188 | |
| 9189 | Example : |
| 9190 | listen www |
| 9191 | mode http |
| 9192 | log global |
| 9193 | server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 |
| 9194 | |
| 9195 | >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \ |
| 9196 | haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \ |
| 9197 | (www/HTTP) |
| 9198 | |
| 9199 | Field Format Extract from the example above |
| 9200 | 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]: |
| 9201 | 2 'Connect from' Connect from |
| 9202 | 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312 |
| 9203 | 4 'to' to |
| 9204 | 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012 |
| 9205 | 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP) |
| 9206 | |
| 9207 | Detailed fields description : |
| 9208 | - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection. |
| 9209 | - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection. |
| 9210 | - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to. |
| 9211 | - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to. |
| 9212 | - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received |
| 9213 | and processed the connection. |
| 9214 | - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP). |
| 9215 | |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9216 | In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as |
| 9217 | "unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the |
| 9218 | connection (the same ID as reported in the stats). |
| 9219 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9220 | It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it |
| 9221 | will eventually disappear. |
| 9222 | |
| 9223 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9224 | 8.2.2. TCP log format |
| 9225 | --------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9226 | |
| 9227 | The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and |
| 9228 | is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious |
| 9229 | information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte |
| 9230 | counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be |
| 9231 | emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most |
| 9232 | environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match |
| 9233 | the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for |
| 9234 | sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by |
Willy Tarreau | c9bd0cc | 2009-05-10 11:57:02 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9235 | specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will |
| 9236 | not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few |
| 9237 | fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are |
| 9238 | marked with a star ('*') after the field name below. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9239 | |
| 9240 | Example : |
| 9241 | frontend fnt |
| 9242 | mode tcp |
| 9243 | option tcplog |
| 9244 | log global |
| 9245 | default_backend bck |
| 9246 | |
| 9247 | backend bck |
| 9248 | server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 |
| 9249 | |
| 9250 | >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \ |
| 9251 | haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \ |
| 9252 | bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0 |
| 9253 | |
| 9254 | Field Format Extract from the example above |
| 9255 | 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]: |
| 9256 | 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313 |
| 9257 | 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] |
| 9258 | 4 frontend_name fnt |
| 9259 | 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1 |
| 9260 | 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007 |
| 9261 | 7 bytes_read* 212 |
| 9262 | 8 termination_state -- |
| 9263 | 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3 |
| 9264 | 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0 |
| 9265 | |
| 9266 | Detailed fields description : |
| 9267 | - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9268 | connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket |
| 9269 | instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that |
| 9270 | when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy" |
| 9271 | and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the |
| 9272 | forwarded connection's information. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9273 | |
| 9274 | - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection. |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9275 | If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be |
| 9276 | replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the |
| 9277 | stats interface. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9278 | |
| 9279 | - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy |
| 9280 | (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the |
| 9281 | network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually |
| 9282 | the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. |
| 9283 | |
| 9284 | - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received |
| 9285 | and processed the connection. |
| 9286 | |
| 9287 | - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected |
| 9288 | to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the |
| 9289 | frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP |
| 9290 | applications. |
| 9291 | |
| 9292 | - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was |
| 9293 | sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors |
| 9294 | and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend |
| 9295 | which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching |
| 9296 | a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. |
| 9297 | |
| 9298 | - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues. |
| 9299 | It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue. |
| 9300 | See "Timers" below for more details. |
| 9301 | |
| 9302 | - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to |
| 9303 | establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the |
| 9304 | connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See |
| 9305 | "Timers" below for more details. |
| 9306 | |
| 9307 | - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the |
| 9308 | last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if |
| 9309 | "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment |
| 9310 | the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value, |
| 9311 | indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more |
| 9312 | details. |
| 9313 | |
| 9314 | - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to |
| 9315 | the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the |
| 9316 | this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one |
| 9317 | may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log |
| 9318 | analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing. |
| 9319 | |
| 9320 | - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session |
| 9321 | ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of |
| 9322 | session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal |
| 9323 | flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with |
| 9324 | no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection" |
| 9325 | for more details. |
| 9326 | |
| 9327 | - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when |
Jamie Gloudon | aaa2100 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 9328 | the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9329 | limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when |
| 9330 | multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits |
| 9331 | the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9332 | are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9333 | |
| 9334 | - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when |
| 9335 | the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource |
| 9336 | required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn" |
| 9337 | has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is |
| 9338 | because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be |
| 9339 | caused by a denial of service attack. |
| 9340 | |
| 9341 | - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the |
| 9342 | backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of |
| 9343 | concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of |
| 9344 | connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of |
| 9345 | additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application. |
| 9346 | Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is |
| 9347 | congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a |
| 9348 | denial of service attack. |
| 9349 | |
| 9350 | - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on |
| 9351 | the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's |
| 9352 | configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal |
| 9353 | to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a |
| 9354 | lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that |
| 9355 | there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response |
| 9356 | time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means |
| 9357 | that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to |
| 9358 | be processed than on other servers. |
| 9359 | |
| 9360 | - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session |
| 9361 | when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a |
| 9362 | server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted. |
| 9363 | Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between |
| 9364 | haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server |
| 9365 | preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be |
| 9366 | prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a |
| 9367 | redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial |
| 9368 | server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the |
| 9369 | connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may |
| 9370 | sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule |
| 9371 | of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count |
| 9372 | should not be attributed to the logged server. |
| 9373 | |
| 9374 | - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before |
| 9375 | this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone |
| 9376 | through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate |
| 9377 | server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of |
| 9378 | requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a |
| 9379 | redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be |
| 9380 | cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the |
| 9381 | backend queue unless a redispatch occurs. |
| 9382 | |
| 9383 | - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before |
| 9384 | this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not |
| 9385 | gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average |
| 9386 | queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when |
| 9387 | divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a |
| 9388 | session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue, |
| 9389 | and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass |
| 9390 | through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch |
| 9391 | occurs. |
| 9392 | |
| 9393 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9394 | 8.2.3. HTTP log format |
| 9395 | ---------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9396 | |
| 9397 | The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It |
| 9398 | is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides |
| 9399 | the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which |
| 9400 | are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually |
| 9401 | emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which |
| 9402 | generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the |
| 9403 | "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for |
| 9404 | which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the |
Willy Tarreau | c9bd0cc | 2009-05-10 11:57:02 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9405 | frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" |
| 9406 | is specified in the frontend. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9407 | |
| 9408 | Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may |
| 9409 | slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked |
| 9410 | with a star ('*') after the field name below. |
| 9411 | |
| 9412 | Example : |
| 9413 | frontend http-in |
| 9414 | mode http |
| 9415 | option httplog |
| 9416 | log global |
| 9417 | default_backend bck |
| 9418 | |
| 9419 | backend static |
| 9420 | server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 |
| 9421 | |
| 9422 | >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \ |
| 9423 | haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \ |
| 9424 | static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \ |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9425 | {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9426 | |
| 9427 | Field Format Extract from the example above |
| 9428 | 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]: |
| 9429 | 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317 |
| 9430 | 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] |
| 9431 | 4 frontend_name http-in |
| 9432 | 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1 |
| 9433 | 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109 |
| 9434 | 7 status_code 200 |
| 9435 | 8 bytes_read* 2750 |
| 9436 | 9 captured_request_cookie - |
| 9437 | 10 captured_response_cookie - |
| 9438 | 11 termination_state ---- |
| 9439 | 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0 |
| 9440 | 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0 |
| 9441 | 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu} |
| 9442 | 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {} |
| 9443 | 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9444 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9445 | |
| 9446 | Detailed fields description : |
| 9447 | - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9448 | connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket |
| 9449 | instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that |
| 9450 | when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy" |
| 9451 | and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the |
| 9452 | forwarded connection's information. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9453 | |
| 9454 | - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection. |
Willy Tarreau | ceb24bc | 2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9455 | If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be |
| 9456 | replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the |
| 9457 | stats interface. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9458 | |
| 9459 | - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by |
| 9460 | haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on |
| 9461 | the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is |
| 9462 | usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This |
| 9463 | does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not. |
| 9464 | |
| 9465 | - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received |
| 9466 | and processed the connection. |
| 9467 | |
| 9468 | - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected |
| 9469 | to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the |
| 9470 | frontend if no switching rule has been applied. |
| 9471 | |
| 9472 | - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was |
| 9473 | sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors |
| 9474 | and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend |
| 9475 | which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a |
| 9476 | server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was |
| 9477 | intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead. |
| 9478 | |
| 9479 | - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send |
| 9480 | a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection |
| 9481 | was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always |
| 9482 | be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large |
| 9483 | times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and |
| 9484 | haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details. |
| 9485 | |
| 9486 | - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues. |
| 9487 | It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue. |
| 9488 | See "Timers" below for more details. |
| 9489 | |
| 9490 | - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to |
| 9491 | establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the |
| 9492 | request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers" |
| 9493 | below for more details. |
| 9494 | |
| 9495 | - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send |
| 9496 | a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was |
| 9497 | aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches |
| 9498 | the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by |
| 9499 | the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on |
| 9500 | "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below |
| 9501 | for more details. |
| 9502 | |
| 9503 | - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the |
| 9504 | last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if |
| 9505 | "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment |
| 9506 | the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value, |
| 9507 | indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more |
| 9508 | details. |
| 9509 | |
| 9510 | - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status |
| 9511 | is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when |
| 9512 | the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy. |
| 9513 | |
| 9514 | - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when |
| 9515 | the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is |
| 9516 | specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that |
| 9517 | the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit |
| 9518 | counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without |
| 9519 | overflowing. |
| 9520 | |
| 9521 | - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that |
| 9522 | the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum |
| 9523 | length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend |
| 9524 | configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not |
| 9525 | set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session |
| 9526 | ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing |
| 9527 | between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult |
| 9528 | the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below. |
| 9529 | |
| 9530 | - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating |
| 9531 | that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name |
| 9532 | and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the |
| 9533 | frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is |
| 9534 | not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track |
| 9535 | session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session |
| 9536 | crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please |
| 9537 | consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below. |
| 9538 | |
| 9539 | - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session |
| 9540 | ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of |
| 9541 | session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP |
| 9542 | logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last |
| 9543 | two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the |
| 9544 | session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See |
| 9545 | below "Session state at disconnection" for more details. |
| 9546 | |
| 9547 | - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when |
Jamie Gloudon | aaa2100 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 9548 | the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9549 | limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024 |
| 9550 | when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system |
| 9551 | limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9552 | of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9553 | system. |
| 9554 | |
| 9555 | - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when |
| 9556 | the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource |
| 9557 | required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn" |
| 9558 | has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is |
| 9559 | because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be |
| 9560 | caused by a denial of service attack. |
| 9561 | |
| 9562 | - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the |
| 9563 | backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of |
| 9564 | concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of |
| 9565 | connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of |
| 9566 | additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application. |
| 9567 | Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is |
| 9568 | congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a |
| 9569 | denial of service attack. |
| 9570 | |
| 9571 | - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on |
| 9572 | the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's |
| 9573 | configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal |
| 9574 | to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a |
| 9575 | lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that |
| 9576 | there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response |
| 9577 | time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means |
| 9578 | that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be |
| 9579 | processed than on other servers. |
| 9580 | |
| 9581 | - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session |
| 9582 | when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a |
| 9583 | server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted. |
| 9584 | Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between |
| 9585 | haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server |
| 9586 | preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be |
| 9587 | prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a |
| 9588 | redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial |
| 9589 | server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the |
| 9590 | connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may |
| 9591 | sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule |
| 9592 | of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count |
| 9593 | should not be attributed to the logged server. |
| 9594 | |
| 9595 | - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before |
| 9596 | this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone |
| 9597 | through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate |
| 9598 | server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of |
| 9599 | requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a |
| 9600 | redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be |
| 9601 | cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the |
| 9602 | backend queue unless a redispatch occurs. |
| 9603 | |
| 9604 | - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before |
| 9605 | this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not |
| 9606 | gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average |
| 9607 | queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when |
| 9608 | divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a |
| 9609 | session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue, |
| 9610 | and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass |
| 9611 | through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch |
| 9612 | occurs. |
| 9613 | |
| 9614 | - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due |
| 9615 | to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend. |
| 9616 | Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar |
| 9617 | ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a |
| 9618 | shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may |
| 9619 | contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when |
| 9620 | it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and |
| 9621 | cookies" below for more details. |
| 9622 | |
| 9623 | - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response |
| 9624 | due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the |
| 9625 | frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a |
| 9626 | vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, |
| 9627 | causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this |
| 9628 | field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser |
| 9629 | than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers |
| 9630 | and cookies" below for more details. |
| 9631 | |
| 9632 | - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method, |
| 9633 | request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see |
| 9634 | below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last |
| 9635 | field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can |
| 9636 | contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be |
| 9637 | added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is |
| 9638 | huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This |
| 9639 | is the reason why this field must always remain the last one. |
| 9640 | |
| 9641 | |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9642 | 8.2.4. Custom log format |
| 9643 | ------------------------ |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9644 | |
William Lallemand | bddd4fd | 2012-02-27 11:23:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9645 | The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp |
| 9646 | mode. It takes a string as argument. |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9647 | |
| 9648 | HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables. |
| 9649 | Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are |
| 9650 | separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by |
| 9651 | prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign. |
| 9652 | |
| 9653 | Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other |
| 9654 | variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted |
| 9655 | string formats ("Q"). |
| 9656 | |
| 9657 | Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator. |
| 9658 | HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators. |
| 9659 | |
| 9660 | Flags are : |
| 9661 | * Q: quote a string |
Jamie Gloudon | aaa2100 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 9662 | * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid) |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9663 | |
| 9664 | Example: |
| 9665 | |
| 9666 | log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text |
| 9667 | log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r |
| 9668 | |
| 9669 | At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way : |
| 9670 | |
| 9671 | log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \ |
Willy Tarreau | 6580c06 | 2012-03-12 15:09:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9672 | %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9673 | |
William Lallemand | bddd4fd | 2012-02-27 11:23:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9674 | the default CLF format is defined this way : |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9675 | |
| 9676 | log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \ |
Willy Tarreau | 6580c06 | 2012-03-12 15:09:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9677 | %ms\ %f\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \ |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9678 | %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl |
| 9679 | |
William Lallemand | bddd4fd | 2012-02-27 11:23:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9680 | and the default TCP format is defined this way : |
| 9681 | |
| 9682 | log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \ |
| 9683 | %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq |
| 9684 | |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9685 | Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables : |
| 9686 | |
William Lallemand | bddd4fd | 2012-02-27 11:23:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9687 | +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+ |
| 9688 | | H | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type | |
| 9689 | +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+ |
| 9690 | | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | | |
| 9691 | +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+ |
| 9692 | | | %B | bytes_read | numeric | |
William Lallemand | 5f23240 | 2012-04-05 18:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9693 | | | %Ci | client_ip | IP | |
William Lallemand | bddd4fd | 2012-02-27 11:23:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9694 | | | %Cp | client_port | numeric | |
William Lallemand | 5f23240 | 2012-04-05 18:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9695 | | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP | |
William Lallemand | b7ff6a3 | 2012-03-02 14:35:21 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9696 | | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric | |
William Lallemand | 5f23240 | 2012-04-05 18:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9697 | | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP | |
| 9698 | | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric | |
| 9699 | | | %H | hostname | string | |
William Lallemand | a73203e | 2012-03-12 12:48:57 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9700 | | | %ID | unique-id | string | |
William Lallemand | 5f23240 | 2012-04-05 18:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9701 | | | %Si | server_IP | IP | |
| 9702 | | | %Sp | server_port | numeric | |
| 9703 | | | %T | gmt_date_time | date | |
William Lallemand | bddd4fd | 2012-02-27 11:23:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9704 | | | %Tc | Tc | numeric | |
| 9705 | | * | %Tq | Tq | numeric | |
| 9706 | | * | %Tr | Tr | numeric | |
William Lallemand | 5f23240 | 2012-04-05 18:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9707 | | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric | |
William Lallemand | bddd4fd | 2012-02-27 11:23:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9708 | | | %Tt | Tt | numeric | |
| 9709 | | | %Tw | Tw | numeric | |
| 9710 | | | %ac | actconn | numeric | |
| 9711 | | | %b | backend_name | string | |
| 9712 | | | %bc | beconn | numeric | |
| 9713 | | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric | |
| 9714 | | * | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string | |
William Lallemand | 5f23240 | 2012-04-05 18:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9715 | | * | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric | |
William Lallemand | bddd4fd | 2012-02-27 11:23:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9716 | | * | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string | |
| 9717 | | | %f | frontend_name | string | |
| 9718 | | | %fc | feconn | numeric | |
| 9719 | | * | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string | |
| 9720 | | * | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list | |
| 9721 | | * | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string | |
| 9722 | | * | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list | |
| 9723 | | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric | |
William Lallemand | 5f23240 | 2012-04-05 18:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9724 | | | %pid | PID | numeric | |
William Lallemand | bddd4fd | 2012-02-27 11:23:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9725 | | * | %r | http_request | string | |
| 9726 | | | %rc | retries | numeric | |
| 9727 | | | %s | server_name | string | |
| 9728 | | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric | |
| 9729 | | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric | |
| 9730 | | * | %st | status_code | numeric | |
William Lallemand | 5f23240 | 2012-04-05 18:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9731 | | | %t | date_time | date | |
William Lallemand | bddd4fd | 2012-02-27 11:23:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9732 | | | %ts | termination_state | string | |
Willy Tarreau | 6580c06 | 2012-03-12 15:09:42 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9733 | | * | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string | |
William Lallemand | bddd4fd | 2012-02-27 11:23:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9734 | +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+ |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9735 | |
William Lallemand | 5f23240 | 2012-04-05 18:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9736 | *: mode http only |
William Lallemand | 4894040 | 2012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9737 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9738 | 8.3. Advanced logging options |
| 9739 | ----------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9740 | |
| 9741 | Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out |
| 9742 | just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few |
| 9743 | options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference |
| 9744 | for more information about their usage. |
| 9745 | |
| 9746 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9747 | 8.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests |
| 9748 | ------------------------------------------ |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9749 | |
| 9750 | It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on |
| 9751 | haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any |
| 9752 | commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete |
| 9753 | monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often |
| 9754 | ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities : |
| 9755 | |
| 9756 | - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often |
| 9757 | desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by |
| 9758 | setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of |
| 9759 | port scans, which may or may not be desired. |
| 9760 | |
| 9761 | - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to |
| 9762 | declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then |
| 9763 | only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be |
| 9764 | logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments |
| 9765 | such as other load-balancers. |
| 9766 | |
| 9767 | - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare |
| 9768 | this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will |
| 9769 | only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged. |
| 9770 | |
| 9771 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9772 | 8.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate |
| 9773 | ---------------------------------------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9774 | |
| 9775 | The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about |
| 9776 | what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions |
| 9777 | or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying |
| 9778 | "option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible, |
| 9779 | just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still |
| 9780 | log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just |
| 9781 | after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported |
| 9782 | is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion |
| 9783 | with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed |
| 9784 | with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger. |
| 9785 | |
| 9786 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9787 | 8.3.3. Raising log level upon errors |
| 9788 | ------------------------------------ |
Willy Tarreau | c9bd0cc | 2009-05-10 11:57:02 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9789 | |
| 9790 | Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs, |
| 9791 | for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option |
| 9792 | "log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts, |
| 9793 | retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level |
| 9794 | raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in |
| 9795 | a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic |
| 9796 | file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if |
| 9797 | you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than |
| 9798 | "notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice". |
| 9799 | |
| 9800 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9801 | 8.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections |
| 9802 | -------------------------------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | c9bd0cc | 2009-05-10 11:57:02 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9803 | |
| 9804 | Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with |
| 9805 | multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping |
| 9806 | them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option |
| 9807 | "dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be |
| 9808 | logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any |
| 9809 | error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too, |
| 9810 | and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged |
| 9811 | too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the |
| 9812 | useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other |
| 9813 | alternative. |
| 9814 | |
| 9815 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9816 | 8.4. Timing events |
| 9817 | ------------------ |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9818 | |
| 9819 | Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are |
| 9820 | reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with |
| 9821 | the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the |
| 9822 | frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP |
| 9823 | mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" : |
| 9824 | |
| 9825 | - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time |
| 9826 | elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the |
| 9827 | moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates |
| 9828 | that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when |
| 9829 | the client closes prematurely or times out. |
| 9830 | |
| 9831 | - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It |
| 9832 | accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the |
| 9833 | queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous |
| 9834 | requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching |
| 9835 | the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests. |
| 9836 | |
| 9837 | - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time |
| 9838 | elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the |
| 9839 | moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and |
| 9840 | the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the |
| 9841 | connection never established. |
| 9842 | |
| 9843 | - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between |
| 9844 | the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment |
| 9845 | the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request |
| 9846 | processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission. |
| 9847 | It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for |
| 9848 | instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort |
| 9849 | apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust |
| 9850 | too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an |
| 9851 | untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response |
| 9852 | header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout |
| 9853 | stroke before the server managed to process the request. |
| 9854 | |
| 9855 | - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it |
| 9856 | and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap" |
| 9857 | option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is |
| 9858 | prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data |
| 9859 | transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid : |
| 9860 | |
| 9861 | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) |
| 9862 | |
| 9863 | Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP |
| 9864 | mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be |
| 9865 | negative. |
| 9866 | |
| 9867 | These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP |
| 9868 | protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure |
| 9869 | that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9870 | due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9871 | close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a |
| 9872 | session has been aborted on timeout. |
| 9873 | |
| 9874 | Most common cases : |
| 9875 | |
| 9876 | - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the |
| 9877 | client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen |
| 9878 | when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may |
| 9879 | happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause. |
| 9880 | Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended, |
| 9881 | haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time |
| 9882 | spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing |
| 9883 | of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of |
| 9884 | a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new |
Patrick Mezard | 105faca | 2010-06-12 17:02:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9885 | connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close" |
| 9886 | may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent |
| 9887 | waiting for additional requests. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9888 | |
| 9889 | - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the |
| 9890 | server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should |
| 9891 | always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens |
| 9892 | of ms on remote networks. |
| 9893 | |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9894 | - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem |
| 9895 | to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost |
| 9896 | between the proxy and the server. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9897 | |
| 9898 | - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because |
| 9899 | neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for |
| 9900 | instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order |
| 9901 | to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on |
| 9902 | either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that |
| 9903 | the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to |
| 9904 | close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the |
| 9905 | smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with |
| 9906 | the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent |
| 9907 | to the server until another one is released. |
| 9908 | |
| 9909 | Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) : |
| 9910 | |
| 9911 | Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log |
| 9912 | was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid |
| 9913 | except "Tt" which is shorter than reality. |
| 9914 | |
| 9915 | -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time |
| 9916 | or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags |
| 9917 | then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings. |
| 9918 | |
| 9919 | Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because |
| 9920 | servers were out of order, because the request was invalid |
| 9921 | or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination |
| 9922 | flags. |
| 9923 | |
| 9924 | Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it |
| 9925 | actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms. |
| 9926 | Check the session termination flags, then check the |
| 9927 | "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might |
| 9928 | return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time |
| 9929 | the client connection was maintained open. |
| 9930 | |
| 9931 | Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return |
| 9932 | a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion |
| 9933 | unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session |
| 9934 | termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting. |
| 9935 | |
| 9936 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9937 | 8.5. Session state at disconnection |
| 9938 | ----------------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9939 | |
| 9940 | TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the |
| 9941 | "termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is |
| 9942 | 2-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode, |
| 9943 | each of which has a special meaning : |
| 9944 | |
| 9945 | - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the |
| 9946 | session to terminate : |
| 9947 | |
| 9948 | C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client. |
| 9949 | |
| 9950 | S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the |
| 9951 | server explicitly refused it. |
| 9952 | |
| 9953 | P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a |
| 9954 | connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched, |
| 9955 | because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous |
| 9956 | error in server response which might have caused information leak |
| 9957 | (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by |
| 9958 | the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...). |
| 9959 | |
| 9960 | R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source |
| 9961 | ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and |
| 9962 | system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this |
| 9963 | happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which |
| 9964 | should be fixed as soon as possible by any means. |
| 9965 | |
| 9966 | I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check. |
| 9967 | This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log |
| 9968 | containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It |
| 9969 | would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an |
| 9970 | event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption. |
| 9971 | |
Simon Horman | 752dc4a | 2011-06-21 14:34:59 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 9972 | D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected |
| 9973 | as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down. |
| 9974 | |
Justin Karneges | eb2c24a | 2012-05-24 15:28:52 -0700 | [diff] [blame] | 9975 | U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an |
| 9976 | active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all |
| 9977 | backup connections when going up. |
| 9978 | |
Willy Tarreau | a2a64e9 | 2011-09-07 23:01:56 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 9979 | K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy. |
| 9980 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9981 | c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to |
| 9982 | send or receive data. |
| 9983 | |
| 9984 | s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to |
| 9985 | send or receive data. |
| 9986 | |
| 9987 | - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed |
| 9988 | with nothing left in the buffers. |
| 9989 | |
| 9990 | - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed : |
| 9991 | |
Willy Tarreau | f7b30a9 | 2010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9992 | R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 9993 | (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server. |
| 9994 | |
| 9995 | Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can |
| 9996 | only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can |
| 9997 | also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to |
| 9998 | a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is |
| 9999 | reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server. |
| 10000 | |
| 10001 | C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the |
| 10002 | server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt. |
| 10003 | |
| 10004 | H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the |
| 10005 | server (HTTP only). |
| 10006 | |
| 10007 | D : the session was in the DATA phase. |
| 10008 | |
| 10009 | L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the |
| 10010 | server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only |
| 10011 | happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets. |
| 10012 | |
| 10013 | T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client |
| 10014 | during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client |
| 10015 | closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer. |
| 10016 | |
| 10017 | - : normal session completion after end of data transfer. |
| 10018 | |
| 10019 | - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by |
| 10020 | the client (only in HTTP mode) : |
| 10021 | |
| 10022 | N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new |
| 10023 | visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the |
| 10024 | logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation. |
| 10025 | |
| 10026 | I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server. |
| 10027 | This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed |
Cyril Bonté | a8e7bbc | 2010-04-25 22:29:29 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10028 | cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally |
| 10029 | ignored, or an attack. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10030 | |
| 10031 | D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN, |
| 10032 | so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to |
| 10033 | this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to |
| 10034 | another server. |
| 10035 | |
Willy Tarreau | 996a92c | 2010-10-13 19:30:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10036 | V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10037 | server. |
| 10038 | |
Willy Tarreau | 996a92c | 2010-10-13 19:30:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10039 | E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was |
| 10040 | older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so |
| 10041 | the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be |
| 10042 | redispatched just as if there was no cookie. |
| 10043 | |
| 10044 | O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was |
| 10045 | older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so |
| 10046 | the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be |
| 10047 | redispatched just as if there was no cookie. |
| 10048 | |
Willy Tarreau | c89ccb6 | 2012-04-05 21:18:22 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10049 | U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because |
| 10050 | some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a |
| 10051 | "use-server" rule). |
| 10052 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10053 | - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration). |
| 10054 | |
| 10055 | - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence |
| 10056 | cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) : |
| 10057 | |
| 10058 | N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either. |
| 10059 | |
| 10060 | I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one. |
| 10061 | Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie, |
| 10062 | it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here. |
| 10063 | |
Willy Tarreau | 996a92c | 2010-10-13 19:30:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10064 | U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by |
| 10065 | the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It |
| 10066 | happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the |
| 10067 | date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as |
| 10068 | a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead. |
| 10069 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10070 | P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is. |
| 10071 | |
| 10072 | R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which |
| 10073 | happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes. |
| 10074 | |
| 10075 | D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy. |
| 10076 | |
| 10077 | - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration). |
| 10078 | |
Willy Tarreau | 996a92c | 2010-10-13 19:30:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10079 | The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what |
| 10080 | was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10081 | helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource |
| 10082 | starvation, attacks, etc... |
| 10083 | |
| 10084 | The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are |
| 10085 | alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for |
| 10086 | easier finding and understanding. |
| 10087 | |
| 10088 | Flags Reason |
| 10089 | |
| 10090 | -- Normal termination. |
| 10091 | |
| 10092 | CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the |
| 10093 | server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently |
| 10094 | dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is |
| 10095 | waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire. |
| 10096 | |
| 10097 | CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be |
| 10098 | caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the |
| 10099 | client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection, |
| 10100 | by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a |
| 10101 | keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first |
| 10102 | by the client. |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10103 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10104 | cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the |
| 10105 | "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10106 | the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10107 | |
| 10108 | CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding. |
| 10109 | It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client |
| 10110 | clicking the 'Stop' button too fast. |
| 10111 | |
| 10112 | cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a |
| 10113 | POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values |
| 10114 | for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can |
| 10115 | also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and |
| 10116 | the server takes too long to respond. |
| 10117 | |
| 10118 | CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server |
| 10119 | with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the |
| 10120 | servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too |
| 10121 | long a time to respond. |
| 10122 | |
| 10123 | CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely |
| 10124 | the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted |
| 10125 | too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this |
| 10126 | might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy |
| 10127 | and the client. |
| 10128 | |
| 10129 | cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP |
| 10130 | request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the |
| 10131 | client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized |
| 10132 | packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast |
| 10133 | enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the |
| 10134 | request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. |
| 10135 | |
| 10136 | CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to |
| 10137 | check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no |
Willy Tarreau | 55165fe | 2009-05-10 12:02:55 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10138 | wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it |
| 10139 | might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something |
| 10140 | closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume |
| 10141 | resources for just a few attackers. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10142 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10143 | SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10144 | the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message |
| 10145 | in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network |
| 10146 | stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route, |
| 10147 | or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode, |
| 10148 | the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here. |
| 10149 | |
| 10150 | sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could |
| 10151 | complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a |
| 10152 | 503 or 504 here. |
| 10153 | |
| 10154 | SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data |
| 10155 | transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from |
| 10156 | the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while |
| 10157 | exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash |
| 10158 | or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment. |
| 10159 | |
| 10160 | sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the |
| 10161 | "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10162 | by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls, |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10163 | load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained |
| 10164 | between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy. |
| 10165 | |
| 10166 | SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or |
| 10167 | it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at |
| 10168 | this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to |
| 10169 | control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a |
| 10170 | small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application. |
| 10171 | Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection |
| 10172 | between haproxy and the server. |
| 10173 | |
| 10174 | sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its |
| 10175 | response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too |
| 10176 | long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation. |
| 10177 | The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server" |
| 10178 | setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience |
| 10179 | will suffer from these long response times. The only long term |
| 10180 | solution is to fix the application. |
| 10181 | |
| 10182 | sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See |
| 10183 | the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to |
| 10184 | fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in |
| 10185 | short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected |
| 10186 | servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by |
| 10187 | external attacks. |
| 10188 | |
| 10189 | PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the |
| 10190 | process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect. |
Cyril Bonté | dc4d903 | 2012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10191 | The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10192 | so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and |
| 10193 | might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand. |
| 10194 | |
Willy Tarreau | ed2fd2d | 2010-12-29 11:23:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10195 | PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in |
| 10196 | a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In |
| 10197 | most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to |
| 10198 | the client. |
| 10199 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10200 | PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid, |
| 10201 | incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter. |
| 10202 | In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible |
| 10203 | cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name |
Willy Tarreau | ed2fd2d | 2010-12-29 11:23:27 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10204 | containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite |
| 10205 | rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the |
| 10206 | client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this |
| 10207 | case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the |
| 10208 | logs. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10209 | |
| 10210 | PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an |
| 10211 | invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to |
| 10212 | the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it |
| 10213 | returned an HTTP 403 error. |
| 10214 | |
| 10215 | PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its |
| 10216 | connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent |
| 10217 | to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as |
| 10218 | reported by the "Tw" timer field. |
| 10219 | |
| 10220 | RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports) |
| 10221 | preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error |
| 10222 | logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can |
| 10223 | only be solved by proper system tuning. |
| 10224 | |
Willy Tarreau | 996a92c | 2010-10-13 19:30:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10225 | The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how |
| 10226 | persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very |
| 10227 | important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to |
| 10228 | re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are : |
| 10229 | |
| 10230 | -- Persistence cookie is not enabled. |
| 10231 | |
| 10232 | NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the |
| 10233 | response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly" |
| 10234 | set on a GET request. |
| 10235 | |
| 10236 | II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client, |
| 10237 | a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when |
Jamie Gloudon | aaa2100 | 2012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400 | [diff] [blame] | 10238 | a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie |
Willy Tarreau | 996a92c | 2010-10-13 19:30:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10239 | value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it. |
| 10240 | |
| 10241 | NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the |
| 10242 | response. This typically happens for first requests from every user |
| 10243 | in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users. |
| 10244 | |
| 10245 | VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the |
| 10246 | response. This happens for most responses for which the client has |
| 10247 | already got a cookie. |
| 10248 | |
| 10249 | VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is |
| 10250 | not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in |
| 10251 | response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if |
| 10252 | there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the |
| 10253 | cookie can be switched to unlimited time. |
| 10254 | |
| 10255 | EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is |
| 10256 | too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a |
| 10257 | new cookie was inserted in the response. |
| 10258 | |
| 10259 | OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is |
| 10260 | too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a |
| 10261 | new cookie was inserted in the response. |
| 10262 | |
| 10263 | DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was |
| 10264 | selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response. |
| 10265 | |
| 10266 | VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not |
| 10267 | be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was |
| 10268 | then advertised in the response. |
| 10269 | |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10270 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10271 | 8.6. Non-printable characters |
| 10272 | ----------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10273 | |
| 10274 | In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log |
| 10275 | consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are |
| 10276 | converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code, |
| 10277 | prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without |
| 10278 | being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the |
| 10279 | escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It |
| 10280 | is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and |
| 10281 | '}' when logging headers. |
| 10282 | |
| 10283 | Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause |
| 10284 | issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header |
| 10285 | containing spaces is "User-Agent". |
| 10286 | |
| 10287 | Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape |
| 10288 | the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be |
| 10289 | performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs. |
| 10290 | |
| 10291 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10292 | 8.7. Capturing HTTP cookies |
| 10293 | --------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10294 | |
| 10295 | Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be |
| 10296 | achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10297 | section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10298 | cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in |
| 10299 | the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in |
| 10300 | the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie" |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10301 | locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10302 | not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a |
| 10303 | user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it |
| 10304 | a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a |
| 10305 | wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing. |
| 10306 | |
| 10307 | Examples : |
| 10308 | # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION" |
| 10309 | capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32 |
| 10310 | |
| 10311 | # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor" |
| 10312 | capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32 |
| 10313 | |
| 10314 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10315 | 8.8. Capturing HTTP headers |
| 10316 | --------------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10317 | |
| 10318 | Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper |
| 10319 | proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In |
| 10320 | the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the |
| 10321 | server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection. |
| 10322 | |
| 10323 | Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture |
| 10324 | response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10325 | section 4.2 for more details. |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10326 | |
| 10327 | It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10328 | time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header |
| 10329 | appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10330 | are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared, |
| 10331 | and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers |
| 10332 | follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the |
| 10333 | request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request |
| 10334 | in the logs. |
| 10335 | |
| 10336 | Example : |
| 10337 | # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy |
| 10338 | listen proxy-out |
| 10339 | mode http |
| 10340 | option httplog |
| 10341 | option logasap |
| 10342 | log global |
| 10343 | server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128 |
| 10344 | |
| 10345 | # log the name of the virtual server |
| 10346 | capture request header Host len 20 |
| 10347 | |
| 10348 | # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST |
| 10349 | capture request header Content-Length len 10 |
| 10350 | |
| 10351 | # log the beginning of the referrer |
| 10352 | capture request header Referer len 20 |
| 10353 | |
| 10354 | # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only) |
| 10355 | capture response header Server len 20 |
| 10356 | |
| 10357 | # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap" |
| 10358 | capture response header Content-Length len 10 |
| 10359 | |
| 10360 | # log the expected cache behaviour on the response |
| 10361 | capture response header Cache-Control len 8 |
| 10362 | |
| 10363 | # the Via header will report the next proxy's name |
| 10364 | capture response header Via len 20 |
| 10365 | |
| 10366 | # log the URL location during a redirection |
| 10367 | capture response header Location len 20 |
| 10368 | |
| 10369 | >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \ |
| 10370 | haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \ |
| 10371 | proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \ |
| 10372 | {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \ |
| 10373 | "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/" |
| 10374 | |
| 10375 | >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \ |
| 10376 | haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \ |
| 10377 | proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \ |
| 10378 | {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \ |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10379 | "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1" |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10380 | |
| 10381 | >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \ |
| 10382 | haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \ |
| 10383 | proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \ |
| 10384 | {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \ |
| 10385 | {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \ |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10386 | "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1" |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10387 | |
| 10388 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10389 | 8.9. Examples of logs |
| 10390 | --------------------- |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10391 | |
| 10392 | These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of |
| 10393 | them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better |
| 10394 | reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them. |
| 10395 | |
| 10396 | >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \ |
| 10397 | px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \ |
| 10398 | "HEAD / HTTP/1.0" |
| 10399 | |
| 10400 | => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied |
| 10401 | in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----') |
| 10402 | |
| 10403 | >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \ |
| 10404 | px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \ |
| 10405 | 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0" |
| 10406 | |
| 10407 | => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other |
| 10408 | requests, and waited there for 1230 ms. |
| 10409 | |
| 10410 | >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \ |
| 10411 | px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \ |
| 10412 | "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0" |
| 10413 | |
| 10414 | => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10415 | the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10416 | 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from |
| 10417 | accept to first data byte is 30 ms. |
| 10418 | |
| 10419 | >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \ |
| 10420 | px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \ |
| 10421 | "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0" |
| 10422 | |
| 10423 | => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or |
| 10424 | "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and |
Willy Tarreau | 3c92c5f | 2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10425 | not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10426 | risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 |
| 10427 | bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided |
| 10428 | to return the 502 and not the server. |
| 10429 | |
| 10430 | >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \ |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10431 | px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 "" |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10432 | |
| 10433 | => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after |
| 10434 | 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--"). |
| 10435 | Nothing was sent to any server. |
| 10436 | |
| 10437 | >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \ |
| 10438 | px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 "" |
| 10439 | |
| 10440 | => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the |
| 10441 | time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request |
| 10442 | headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could |
| 10443 | send a 408 return code to the client. |
| 10444 | |
| 10445 | >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \ |
| 10446 | px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 |
| 10447 | |
| 10448 | => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after |
| 10449 | 5 seconds ("c----"). |
| 10450 | |
| 10451 | >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \ |
| 10452 | px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \ |
Willy Tarreau | d72758d | 2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10453 | 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0" |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10454 | |
| 10455 | => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10456 | connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds |
Willy Tarreau | cc6c891 | 2009-02-22 10:53:55 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10457 | (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have |
| 10458 | seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115 |
| 10459 | connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on |
| 10460 | the global process. It is possible that the server refused the |
| 10461 | connection because of too many already established. |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10462 | |
Willy Tarreau | 3dfe6cd | 2008-12-07 22:29:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10463 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10464 | 9. Statistics and monitoring |
| 10465 | ---------------------------- |
| 10466 | |
| 10467 | It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used |
| 10468 | mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative |
| 10469 | CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the |
| 10470 | Unix socket. |
| 10471 | |
| 10472 | |
| 10473 | 9.1. CSV format |
Willy Tarreau | 3dfe6cd | 2008-12-07 22:29:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10474 | --------------- |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f58a962 | 2008-02-23 01:19:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10475 | |
Willy Tarreau | 7f062c4 | 2009-03-05 18:43:00 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10476 | The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP |
| 10477 | page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. |
| 10478 | |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f58a962 | 2008-02-23 01:19:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10479 | 0. pxname: proxy name |
| 10480 | 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name |
| 10481 | for server) |
| 10482 | 2. qcur: current queued requests |
| 10483 | 3. qmax: max queued requests |
| 10484 | 4. scur: current sessions |
| 10485 | 5. smax: max sessions |
| 10486 | 6. slim: sessions limit |
| 10487 | 7. stot: total sessions |
| 10488 | 8. bin: bytes in |
| 10489 | 9. bout: bytes out |
| 10490 | 10. dreq: denied requests |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 2c6962c | 2008-03-02 02:42:14 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10491 | 11. dresp: denied responses |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f58a962 | 2008-02-23 01:19:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10492 | 12. ereq: request errors |
| 10493 | 13. econ: connection errors |
Willy Tarreau | ae52678 | 2010-03-04 20:34:23 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10494 | 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt) |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f58a962 | 2008-02-23 01:19:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10495 | 15. wretr: retries (warning) |
| 10496 | 16. wredis: redispatches (warning) |
Cyril Bonté | 0dae585 | 2010-02-03 00:26:28 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10497 | 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...) |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f58a962 | 2008-02-23 01:19:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10498 | 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend) |
| 10499 | 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend) |
| 10500 | 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend) |
| 10501 | 21. chkfail: number of failed checks |
| 10502 | 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions |
| 10503 | 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds) |
| 10504 | 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds) |
| 10505 | 25. qlimit: queue limit |
| 10506 | 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...) |
| 10507 | 27. iid: unique proxy id |
| 10508 | 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy) |
| 10509 | 29. throttle: warm up status |
| 10510 | 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected |
| 10511 | 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | aeebf9b | 2009-10-04 15:43:17 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10512 | 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket) |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | db57c6b | 2009-08-31 21:23:27 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10513 | 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second |
| 10514 | 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second |
| 10515 | 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 0960541 | 2009-09-23 22:09:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10516 | 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of: |
Cyril Bonté | f0c6061 | 2010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10517 | UNK -> unknown |
| 10518 | INI -> initializing |
| 10519 | SOCKERR -> socket error |
| 10520 | L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled |
| 10521 | L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout |
| 10522 | L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example |
| 10523 | "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp) |
| 10524 | L6OK -> check passed on layer 6 |
| 10525 | L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout |
| 10526 | L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error |
| 10527 | L7OK -> check passed on layer 7 |
| 10528 | L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with |
| 10529 | disable-on-404 |
| 10530 | L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout |
| 10531 | L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error |
| 10532 | L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 0960541 | 2009-09-23 22:09:24 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10533 | 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available |
| 10534 | 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10535 | 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code |
| 10536 | 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code |
| 10537 | 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code |
| 10538 | 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code |
| 10539 | 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code |
| 10540 | 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error) |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10541 | 45. hanafail: failed health checks details |
| 10542 | 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second |
| 10543 | 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed |
| 10544 | 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received |
Willy Tarreau | ae52678 | 2010-03-04 20:34:23 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10545 | 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client |
| 10546 | 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp) |
Willy Tarreau | 844e3c5 | 2008-01-11 16:28:18 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10547 | |
Willy Tarreau | 3dfe6cd | 2008-12-07 22:29:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10548 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10549 | 9.2. Unix Socket commands |
Willy Tarreau | 3dfe6cd | 2008-12-07 22:29:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10550 | ------------------------- |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 2c6962c | 2008-03-02 02:42:14 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10551 | |
Willy Tarreau | 3dfe6cd | 2008-12-07 22:29:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10552 | The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them |
Willy Tarreau | 9a42c0d | 2009-09-22 19:31:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10553 | must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it |
| 10554 | is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by |
| 10555 | a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no |
| 10556 | risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be |
| 10557 | followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a |
| 10558 | given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed |
| 10559 | then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines |
| 10560 | to be issued one at a time. |
Willy Tarreau | 3dfe6cd | 2008-12-07 22:29:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10561 | |
Willy Tarreau | 9a42c0d | 2009-09-22 19:31:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10562 | It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started |
| 10563 | on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its |
| 10564 | own stats. |
Willy Tarreau | 3dfe6cd | 2008-12-07 22:29:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10565 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10566 | clear counters |
| 10567 | Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & |
| 10568 | backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This |
| 10569 | can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to |
| 10570 | restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can |
| 10571 | only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin". |
| 10572 | |
| 10573 | clear counters all |
| 10574 | Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each |
| 10575 | server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted |
| 10576 | and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". |
| 10577 | |
Simon Horman | c88b887 | 2011-06-15 15:18:49 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10578 | clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ] |
| 10579 | Remove entries from the stick-table <table>. |
| 10580 | |
| 10581 | This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been |
| 10582 | abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some |
| 10583 | stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show |
| 10584 | table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be |
| 10585 | refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds |
| 10586 | later after the session ends is usual enough. |
| 10587 | |
| 10588 | In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed. |
| 10589 | |
| 10590 | When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the |
| 10591 | stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data |
| 10592 | type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the |
| 10593 | table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to |
| 10594 | <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with |
| 10595 | the ACLs : |
| 10596 | |
| 10597 | - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value |
| 10598 | - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value |
| 10599 | - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value |
| 10600 | - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value |
| 10601 | - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value |
| 10602 | - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value |
| 10603 | |
| 10604 | When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the |
Simon Horman | 619e3cc | 2011-06-15 15:18:52 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10605 | same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and |
| 10606 | string. |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10607 | |
| 10608 | Example : |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10609 | $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 |
Emeric Brun | 7c6b82e | 2010-09-24 16:34:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10610 | >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2 |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10611 | >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \ |
| 10612 | bytes_out_rate(60000)=187 |
| 10613 | >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \ |
| 10614 | bytes_out_rate(60000)=191 |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10615 | |
| 10616 | $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 |
| 10617 | |
| 10618 | $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 |
Emeric Brun | 7c6b82e | 2010-09-24 16:34:28 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10619 | >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1 |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10620 | >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \ |
| 10621 | bytes_out_rate(60000)=191 |
Simon Horman | c88b887 | 2011-06-15 15:18:49 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10622 | $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 |
| 10623 | $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 |
| 10624 | >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1 |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10625 | |
Willy Tarreau | 532a450 | 2011-09-07 22:37:44 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10626 | disable frontend <frontend> |
| 10627 | Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which |
| 10628 | is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be |
| 10629 | enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes |
| 10630 | are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments |
| 10631 | where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must |
| 10632 | be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another |
| 10633 | process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP" |
| 10634 | on the stats page. |
| 10635 | |
| 10636 | The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID, |
| 10637 | prefixed with a sharp ('#'). |
| 10638 | |
| 10639 | This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for |
| 10640 | level "admin". |
| 10641 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10642 | disable server <backend>/<server> |
| 10643 | Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be |
| 10644 | performed on the server until it leaves maintenance. |
| 10645 | If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN |
| 10646 | during the maintenance. |
| 10647 | |
| 10648 | In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a |
| 10649 | "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one. |
| 10650 | |
| 10651 | Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by |
Willy Tarreau | f5f3192 | 2011-08-02 11:32:07 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10652 | their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#'). |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10653 | |
| 10654 | This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for |
| 10655 | level "admin". |
| 10656 | |
Willy Tarreau | 532a450 | 2011-09-07 22:37:44 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10657 | enable frontend <frontend> |
| 10658 | Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of |
| 10659 | the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process |
| 10660 | took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error |
| 10661 | is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend |
| 10662 | which was disabled. |
| 10663 | |
| 10664 | The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID, |
| 10665 | prefixed with a sharp ('#'). |
| 10666 | |
| 10667 | This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for |
| 10668 | level "admin". |
| 10669 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10670 | enable server <backend>/<server> |
| 10671 | If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the |
| 10672 | server UP and checks are re-enabled. |
| 10673 | |
| 10674 | Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by |
Willy Tarreau | f5f3192 | 2011-08-02 11:32:07 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10675 | their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#'). |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10676 | |
| 10677 | This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for |
| 10678 | level "admin". |
| 10679 | |
| 10680 | get weight <backend>/<server> |
| 10681 | Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in |
| 10682 | backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is |
| 10683 | the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal |
| 10684 | unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server |
| 10685 | may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a |
Willy Tarreau | f5f3192 | 2011-08-02 11:32:07 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10686 | sharp ('#'). |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10687 | |
Willy Tarreau | 9a42c0d | 2009-09-22 19:31:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10688 | help |
| 10689 | Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen |
| 10690 | is also displayed for unknown commands. |
Willy Tarreau | 3dfe6cd | 2008-12-07 22:29:48 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10691 | |
Willy Tarreau | 9a42c0d | 2009-09-22 19:31:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10692 | prompt |
| 10693 | Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive |
| 10694 | mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command |
| 10695 | completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that |
| 10696 | the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right |
| 10697 | angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient |
| 10698 | when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors. |
| 10699 | It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help" |
| 10700 | command. |
| 10701 | |
| 10702 | quit |
| 10703 | Close the connection when in interactive mode. |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 2c6962c | 2008-03-02 02:42:14 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10704 | |
Willy Tarreau | 2a0f4d2 | 2011-08-02 11:49:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10705 | set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value> |
Willy Tarreau | 3c7a79d | 2012-09-26 21:07:15 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10706 | Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive |
| 10707 | value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global |
| 10708 | maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections |
| 10709 | were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value |
| 10710 | below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be |
Willy Tarreau | 2a0f4d2 | 2011-08-02 11:49:05 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10711 | delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by |
| 10712 | either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#'). |
| 10713 | |
Willy Tarreau | 91886b6 | 2011-09-07 14:38:31 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10714 | set maxconn global <maxconn> |
| 10715 | Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the |
| 10716 | initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were |
| 10717 | pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below |
| 10718 | the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be |
| 10719 | delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial |
| 10720 | setting. |
| 10721 | |
Willy Tarreau | f5b2287 | 2011-09-07 16:13:44 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10722 | set rate-limit connections global <value> |
| 10723 | Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global |
| 10724 | 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit |
| 10725 | applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value |
| 10726 | is passed in number of connections per second. |
| 10727 | |
Willy Tarreau | 654694e | 2012-06-07 01:03:16 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10728 | set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value> |
| 10729 | Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present, |
| 10730 | an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible |
| 10731 | values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering |
| 10732 | entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an |
| 10733 | IP address or affect its quality of service. |
| 10734 | |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10735 | set timeout cli <delay> |
| 10736 | Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful |
| 10737 | during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect |
| 10738 | some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds. |
| 10739 | |
| 10740 | set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%] |
| 10741 | Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends |
| 10742 | with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially |
| 10743 | configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%, |
| 10744 | and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part |
| 10745 | of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations |
| 10746 | because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only |
| 10747 | accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take |
| 10748 | effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of |
| 10749 | requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable |
| 10750 | a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it |
| 10751 | again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted |
| 10752 | and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the |
| 10753 | backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their |
Willy Tarreau | f5f3192 | 2011-08-02 11:32:07 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10754 | numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#'). |
Willy Tarreau | d63335a | 2010-02-26 12:56:52 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10755 | |
Willy Tarreau | e0c8a1a | 2009-03-04 16:33:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10756 | show errors [<iid>] |
| 10757 | Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and |
| 10758 | backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning |
Willy Tarreau | 6162db2 | 2009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10759 | either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted |
| 10760 | and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or |
| 10761 | "admin". |
Willy Tarreau | e0c8a1a | 2009-03-04 16:33:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10762 | |
| 10763 | The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors |
| 10764 | caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header |
| 10765 | names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the |
| 10766 | protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was |
| 10767 | detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the |
| 10768 | internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session |
| 10769 | are reported too. |
| 10770 | |
| 10771 | All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The |
| 10772 | most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one |
| 10773 | letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to |
| 10774 | avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where |
| 10775 | NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII |
| 10776 | code. |
| 10777 | |
| 10778 | Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0 |
| 10779 | for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line, |
| 10780 | and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that |
| 10781 | the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a |
| 10782 | line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset |
| 10783 | will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous |
| 10784 | line. |
| 10785 | |
| 10786 | Example : |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10787 | $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 |
| 10788 | >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response |
Willy Tarreau | e0c8a1a | 2009-03-04 16:33:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10789 | src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1) |
| 10790 | response length 213 bytes, error at position 23: |
| 10791 | |
| 10792 | 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n |
| 10793 | 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n |
| 10794 | 00038 Location: blah\r\n |
| 10795 | 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b |
| 10796 | 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer, |
| 10797 | 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter |
| 10798 | 00204+ minal\r\n |
| 10799 | 00211 \r\n |
| 10800 | |
Willy Tarreau | c57f0e2 | 2009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10801 | In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal |
Willy Tarreau | e0c8a1a | 2009-03-04 16:33:10 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10802 | ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal |
| 10803 | ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and |
| 10804 | received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was |
| 10805 | 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This |
| 10806 | is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid |
| 10807 | HTTP character for a header name. |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 2c6962c | 2008-03-02 02:42:14 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10808 | |
Willy Tarreau | 9a42c0d | 2009-09-22 19:31:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10809 | show info |
| 10810 | Dump info about haproxy status on current process. |
| 10811 | |
| 10812 | show sess |
| 10813 | Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can |
Willy Tarreau | 6162db2 | 2009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10814 | be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets |
| 10815 | configured for levels "operator" or "admin". |
| 10816 | |
Willy Tarreau | 66dc20a | 2010-03-05 17:53:32 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10817 | show sess <id> |
| 10818 | Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier. |
| 10819 | This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps |
| 10820 | of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are |
| 10821 | useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a |
| 10822 | complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can |
| 10823 | freely evolve depending on demands. |
Willy Tarreau | 9a42c0d | 2009-09-22 19:31:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10824 | |
| 10825 | show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>] |
| 10826 | Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is |
| 10827 | possible to dump only selected items : |
| 10828 | - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything |
| 10829 | - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for |
| 10830 | backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed, |
| 10831 | for example: |
| 10832 | 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend. |
| 10833 | 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server. |
| 10834 | - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy. |
| 10835 | |
| 10836 | Example : |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10837 | $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1 |
| 10838 | >>> Name: HAProxy |
Willy Tarreau | 9a42c0d | 2009-09-22 19:31:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10839 | Version: 1.4-dev2-49 |
| 10840 | Release_date: 2009/09/23 |
| 10841 | Nbproc: 1 |
| 10842 | Process_num: 1 |
| 10843 | (...) |
| 10844 | |
| 10845 | # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...) |
| 10846 | stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...) |
| 10847 | stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...) |
| 10848 | (...) |
| 10849 | www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...) |
| 10850 | |
| 10851 | $ |
| 10852 | |
| 10853 | Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find |
| 10854 | which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty |
| 10855 | line after the information output which marks the end of the first block. |
| 10856 | A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | f864533 | 2009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10857 | the reader knows the output has not been truncated. |
Willy Tarreau | 9a42c0d | 2009-09-22 19:31:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10858 | |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10859 | show table |
| 10860 | Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned |
| 10861 | (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always |
| 10862 | IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of |
| 10863 | entries currently in use. |
| 10864 | |
| 10865 | Example : |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10866 | $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 |
Simon Horman | 64b28d0 | 2011-08-13 08:03:50 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10867 | >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454 |
| 10868 | >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0 |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10869 | |
Simon Horman | 17bce34 | 2011-06-15 15:18:47 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10870 | show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ] |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10871 | Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic |
| 10872 | information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all |
| 10873 | entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify |
Simon Horman | 17bce34 | 2011-06-15 15:18:47 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10874 | a filter in order to specify what entries to display. |
| 10875 | |
| 10876 | When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see |
| 10877 | "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified |
| 10878 | in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an |
| 10879 | error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the |
| 10880 | 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs : |
| 10881 | |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10882 | - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value |
| 10883 | - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value |
| 10884 | - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value |
| 10885 | - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value |
| 10886 | - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value |
| 10887 | - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value |
| 10888 | |
Simon Horman | c88b887 | 2011-06-15 15:18:49 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10889 | |
| 10890 | When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the |
Simon Horman | 619e3cc | 2011-06-15 15:18:52 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10891 | same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer, |
| 10892 | and string. |
Simon Horman | 17bce34 | 2011-06-15 15:18:47 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10893 | |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10894 | Example : |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10895 | $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 |
Simon Horman | 64b28d0 | 2011-08-13 08:03:50 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10896 | >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2 |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10897 | >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \ |
| 10898 | bytes_out_rate(60000)=187 |
| 10899 | >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \ |
| 10900 | bytes_out_rate(60000)=191 |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10901 | |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10902 | $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 |
Simon Horman | 64b28d0 | 2011-08-13 08:03:50 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10903 | >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2 |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10904 | >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \ |
| 10905 | bytes_out_rate(60000)=191 |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10906 | |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10907 | $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \ |
| 10908 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 |
Simon Horman | 64b28d0 | 2011-08-13 08:03:50 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10909 | >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2 |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10910 | >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \ |
| 10911 | bytes_out_rate(60000)=191 |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10912 | |
Simon Horman | 17bce34 | 2011-06-15 15:18:47 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10913 | $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \ |
| 10914 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 |
Simon Horman | 64b28d0 | 2011-08-13 08:03:50 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10915 | >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2 |
Simon Horman | 17bce34 | 2011-06-15 15:18:47 +0900 | [diff] [blame] | 10916 | >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \ |
| 10917 | bytes_out_rate(60000)=191 |
| 10918 | |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10919 | When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as |
| 10920 | a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the |
| 10921 | entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that |
| 10922 | such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as |
| 10923 | time goes, the average event rate drops. |
| 10924 | |
| 10925 | It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the |
| 10926 | service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall. |
| 10927 | Example : |
Willy Tarreau | 62a36c4 | 2010-08-17 15:53:10 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10928 | $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \ |
| 10929 | | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \ |
Willy Tarreau | 88bc4ec | 2010-08-01 07:58:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10930 | | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt |
| 10931 | ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' ) |
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki | 719e726 | 2009-10-04 15:02:46 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10932 | |
Willy Tarreau | 532a450 | 2011-09-07 22:37:44 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10933 | shutdown frontend <frontend> |
| 10934 | Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will |
| 10935 | be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after |
| 10936 | this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a |
| 10937 | proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That |
| 10938 | way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to |
| 10939 | restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page |
| 10940 | once it is terminated. |
| 10941 | |
| 10942 | The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID, |
| 10943 | prefixed with a sharp ('#'). |
| 10944 | |
| 10945 | This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for |
| 10946 | level "admin". |
| 10947 | |
Willy Tarreau | a295edc | 2011-09-07 23:21:03 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10948 | shutdown session <id> |
| 10949 | Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier. |
| 10950 | This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps |
| 10951 | of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to |
| 10952 | terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an |
| 10953 | endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K' |
| 10954 | flag in the logs. |
| 10955 | |
Willy Tarreau | 52b2d22 | 2011-09-07 23:48:48 +0200 | [diff] [blame] | 10956 | shutdown sessions <backend>/<server> |
| 10957 | Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This |
| 10958 | can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into |
| 10959 | maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a |
| 10960 | 'K' flag in the logs. |
| 10961 | |
Willy Tarreau | 0ba2750 | 2007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100 | [diff] [blame] | 10962 | /* |
| 10963 | * Local variables: |
| 10964 | * fill-column: 79 |
| 10965 | * End: |
| 10966 | */ |